blob: 34a925020e8f80ded09233c57bcf43a986502399 [file] [log] [blame]
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001//===- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes --------------===//
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000016#include "clang/AST/APValue.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000017#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTTypeTraits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000020#include "clang/AST/AttrIterator.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000021#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000022#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000023#include "clang/AST/Decl.h"
24#include "clang/AST/DeclBase.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000025#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Chandler Carruthaa36b892015-12-30 03:40:23 +000026#include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000027#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000028#include "clang/AST/DeclOpenMP.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000029#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000030#include "clang/AST/DeclarationName.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000031#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000032#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000033#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000034#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000035#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000036#include "clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h"
37#include "clang/AST/RawCommentList.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000038#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000039#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000040#include "clang/AST/Stmt.h"
41#include "clang/AST/TemplateBase.h"
42#include "clang/AST/TemplateName.h"
43#include "clang/AST/Type.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000044#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000045#include "clang/AST/UnresolvedSet.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000046#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000047#include "clang/Basic/AddressSpaces.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000048#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000049#include "clang/Basic/CommentOptions.h"
50#include "clang/Basic/IdentifierTable.h"
51#include "clang/Basic/LLVM.h"
52#include "clang/Basic/LangOptions.h"
53#include "clang/Basic/Linkage.h"
54#include "clang/Basic/ObjCRuntime.h"
55#include "clang/Basic/SanitizerBlacklist.h"
56#include "clang/Basic/SourceLocation.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000057#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000058#include "clang/Basic/Specifiers.h"
59#include "clang/Basic/TargetCXXABI.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000060#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000061#include "clang/Basic/XRayLists.h"
62#include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
63#include "llvm/ADT/APSInt.h"
64#include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
65#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
66#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
67#include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h"
68#include "llvm/ADT/None.h"
69#include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
70#include "llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h"
71#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
72#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
73#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000074#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000075#include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000076#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000077#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000078#include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
79#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
80#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000081#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000082#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000083#include <algorithm>
84#include <cassert>
85#include <cstddef>
86#include <cstdint>
87#include <cstdlib>
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000088#include <map>
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000089#include <memory>
90#include <string>
91#include <tuple>
92#include <utility>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000093
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000094using namespace clang;
95
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000096unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
97unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000098unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
99unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +0000100unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
101unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +0000102unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
103unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +0000104unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
105unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000106unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
107unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
108
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +0000109enum FloatingRank {
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +0000110 Float16Rank, HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank, Float128Rank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +0000111};
112
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +0000113RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000114 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
115 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +0000116
117#ifndef NDEBUG
118 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
119 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
120 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
121#endif
122
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000123 CommentsLoaded = true;
124 }
125
126 assert(D);
127
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +0000128 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
129 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000130 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +0000131
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000132 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
133 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
134 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000135 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000136 }
137
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000138 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
139 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
140 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000141 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000142 }
143
144 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
145 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000146 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000147 }
148
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000149 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
150 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
151 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
152 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
153 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000154 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000155 }
156
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000157 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
158 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000159 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000160 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000161 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
162 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
163 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
164 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000165 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000166 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
168 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000169 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000170
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000171 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
172 // documentation.
173 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
174 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
175 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000176 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000177
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000178 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000179
180 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
181 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000182 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000183
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000184 // Find declaration location.
185 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
186 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
187 // location".
188 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
189 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
190 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
191 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000192 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000193 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
194 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000195 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000196 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000197 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000198 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
199 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
200 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
201 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
202 // the "declaration location".
203 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
204 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
205 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
206 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
207 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
208 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
209 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
210 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
211 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
212 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
213 }
214 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000215 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000216
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000217 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
218 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000219 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000220 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000221
222 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000223 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
224 {
225 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
226 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
227 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000228 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
229 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
230 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000231 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
232 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
233 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
234 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
235 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
236 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
237 }
238
239 if (Found) {
240 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
241 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
242 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
243 } else {
244 // Slow path.
245 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
246 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
247 }
248 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000249
250 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
251 // file buffer.
252 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
253
254 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
255 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000257 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000258 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000259 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000260 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000261 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
262 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
263 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
264 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
265 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
266 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000267 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000268 }
269 }
270
271 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
272 // Let's look at the previous comment.
273 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000274 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000275 --Comment;
276
277 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000278 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000279 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000280
281 // Decompose the end of the comment.
282 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000283 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000284
285 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
286 // aren't related.
287 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000288 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000289
290 // Get the corresponding buffer.
291 bool Invalid = false;
292 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
293 &Invalid).data();
294 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000295 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000296
297 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
298 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
299 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
300
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000301 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
302 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000303 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000304 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000305
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000306 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000307}
308
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000309/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
310/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000311/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +0000312static const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000313 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000314 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000315 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000316 return FTD;
317
318 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
319 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
320 return D;
321
322 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
323 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
324 return FTD;
325
326 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
327 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
328 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
329 return MemberDecl;
330
331 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000332 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000333 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
334 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
335 // template?
336 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
337 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
338 return MemberDecl;
339
340 return D;
341 }
342 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
343 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
344 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
345 return CTD;
346
347 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
348 // specialization?
349 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
350 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
351 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
352 return D;
353 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
354 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
355 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
356 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
357 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
358 static_cast<const Decl*>(
359 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
360 }
361
362 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
363 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
364 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
365 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
366
367 return D;
368 }
369 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
370 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
371 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
372 return MemberDecl;
373
374 return D;
375 }
376 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000377 return D;
378}
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000379
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000380const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
381 const Decl *D,
382 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000383 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000384
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000385 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
386 {
387 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
388 RedeclComments.find(D);
389 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
390 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000391 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
392 if (OriginalDecl)
393 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000395 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000396 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000397 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000398
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000399 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000400 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
401 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000402 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000403 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000404 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000405 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
406 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
407 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
408 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000409 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000410 break;
411 }
412 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000413 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
414 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000415 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
416 if (RC) {
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000417 // Call order swapped to work around ICE in VS2015 RTM (Release Win32)
418 // https://connect.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/feedback/details/1741530
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000419 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000420 Raw.setRaw(RC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000421 } else
422 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000423 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
424 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000425 if (RC)
426 break;
427 }
428 }
429
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000430 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
431 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000432
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000433 if (OriginalDecl)
434 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
435
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000436 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
437 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
438 Raw.setRaw(RC);
439 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000440 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000441
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000442 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
443 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000444 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
445 R = Raw;
446 }
447
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000448 return RC;
449}
450
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000451static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
452 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
453 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
454 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
455 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
456 if (!ID)
457 return;
458 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000459 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000460 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000461 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
463 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
464 }
465 }
466}
467
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000468comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
469 const Decl *D) const {
470 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
471 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
472 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
473 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
474 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000475 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
476 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000477 comments::FullComment *CFC =
478 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
479 ThisDeclInfo);
480 return CFC;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000481}
482
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000483comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
484 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000485 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000486}
487
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000488comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
489 const Decl *D,
490 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000491 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000492 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000493 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000494
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000495 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
496 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
497 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000498
499 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000500 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000501 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000502 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000503 return CFC;
504 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000505 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000506 }
507
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000508 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000509
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000510 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000511 if (!RC) {
512 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000513 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000514 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000515 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
516 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
517 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
518 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000519 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000520 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
521 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000522 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
523 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
524 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000525 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000526 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000527 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000528 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000529 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000530 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
531 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
532 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000533 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000534 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000535 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
536 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
537 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
538 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
539 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
540 }
541 }
542 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
543 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
544 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
545 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
546 }
547 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
548 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000549 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000550 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000551 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
552 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000553 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000554 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000555 if (Ty.isNull())
556 continue;
557 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
558 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
559 continue;
560
561 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
562 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
563 }
564 }
565 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000566 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
567 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000568 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000569 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000570 if (Ty.isNull())
571 continue;
572 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
573 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
574 continue;
575 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
576 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
577 }
578 }
579 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000580 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000581 }
582
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000583 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
584 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
585 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
586 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000587 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000588 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000589
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000590 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000591 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
592 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000593}
594
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000595void
596ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
597 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
598 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
599 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000600 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000601
602 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
603 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
604 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
605 PEnd = Params->end();
606 P != PEnd; ++P) {
607 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
608 ID.AddInteger(0);
609 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
610 continue;
611 }
612
613 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
614 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000615 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000616 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000617 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
618 ID.AddBoolean(true);
619 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000620 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
621 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
622 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
623 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000624 } else
625 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000626 continue;
627 }
628
629 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
630 ID.AddInteger(2);
631 Profile(ID, TTP);
632 }
633}
634
635TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
636ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000637 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000638 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
639 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
640 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000641 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000642 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
643 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
644 if (Canonical)
645 return Canonical->getParam();
646
647 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
648 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000649 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
651 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
652 PEnd = Params->end();
653 P != PEnd; ++P) {
654 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
655 CanonParams.push_back(
656 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000657 SourceLocation(),
658 SourceLocation(),
659 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000660 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000661 TTP->isParameterPack()));
662 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000663 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
664 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
665 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
666 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
667 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000668 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
669 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000670 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
671 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
672 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
673 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
674 }
675
676 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000677 SourceLocation(),
678 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000679 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000680 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000681 T,
682 TInfo,
David Majnemerdfecf1a2016-07-06 04:19:16 +0000683 ExpandedTypes,
684 ExpandedTInfos);
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000685 } else {
686 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000687 SourceLocation(),
688 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000689 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000690 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000691 T,
692 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
693 TInfo);
694 }
695 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
696
697 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000698 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
699 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
700 }
701
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000702 assert(!TTP->getRequiresClause() &&
703 "Unexpected requires-clause on template template-parameter");
George Burgess IVb7e4e482016-08-25 01:54:37 +0000704 Expr *const CanonRequiresClause = nullptr;
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000705
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000706 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
707 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
708 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000709 TTP->getPosition(),
710 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000711 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000712 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
713 SourceLocation(),
David Majnemer902f8c62015-12-27 07:16:27 +0000714 CanonParams,
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000715 SourceLocation(),
716 CanonRequiresClause));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000717
718 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
719 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000720 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000721 (void)Canonical;
722
723 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
724 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
725 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
726 return CanonTTP;
727}
728
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000729CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000730 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000731
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000732 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000733 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000734 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000735 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +0000736 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000737 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +0000738 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000739 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +0000740 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000741 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000742 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000743 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
744 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000745 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000746}
747
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +0000748static const LangASMap *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
749 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000750 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
751 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
752 // language-specific address space.
753 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
Yaxun Liub34ec822017-04-11 17:24:23 +0000754 0, // Default
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000755 1, // opencl_global
Egor Churaev28f00aa2016-12-23 16:11:25 +0000756 3, // opencl_local
757 2, // opencl_constant
Yaxun Liub7318e02017-10-13 03:37:48 +0000758 0, // opencl_private
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000759 4, // opencl_generic
760 5, // cuda_device
761 6, // cuda_constant
762 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000763 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000764 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000765 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000766 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000767 }
768}
769
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000770static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
771 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
772 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000773 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
774 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
775 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
776 return true;
777 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
778 return false;
779 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000780 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000781}
782
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000783ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000784 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000785 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000786 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
787 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +0000788 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()), SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova511cdd2015-02-04 17:40:08 +0000789 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
Dean Michael Berris835832d2017-03-30 00:29:36 +0000790 XRayFilter(new XRayFunctionFilter(LangOpts.XRayAlwaysInstrumentFiles,
791 LangOpts.XRayNeverInstrumentFiles, SM)),
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000792 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +0000793 BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), Comments(SM),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000794 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000795 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
796}
797
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000798ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000799 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
800
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000801 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
802 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
803 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000804
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000805 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000806 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
807 (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000808
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000809 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000810 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
811 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
812 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
813 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
814 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
815 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
816 R->Destroy(*this);
817
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000818 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
819 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
820 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
821 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
822 R->Destroy(*this);
823 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000824
825 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
826 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
827 A != AEnd; ++A)
828 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000829
David Majnemere694f3e2015-08-14 14:43:50 +0000830 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair :
831 MaterializedTemporaryValues)
832 MTVPair.second->~APValue();
833
Richard Smith423f46f2016-07-20 21:38:26 +0000834 for (const auto &Value : ModuleInitializers)
835 Value.second->~PerModuleInitializers();
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000836}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000837
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000838void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +0000839 if (!PointerParents) return;
840 for (const auto &Entry : *PointerParents) {
841 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
842 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
843 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
844 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
845 }
846 }
847 for (const auto &Entry : *OtherParents) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000848 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
849 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +0000850 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000851 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
852 }
853 }
854}
855
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000856void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000857 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000858}
859
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000860void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000861ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
Benjamin Kramerd6da1a02016-06-12 20:05:23 +0000862 ExternalSource = std::move(Source);
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000863}
864
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000865void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000866 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
867 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000868
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000869 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000870#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000871#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
872#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
873 0 // Extra
874 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000875
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000876 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
877 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000878 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000879 }
880
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000881 unsigned Idx = 0;
882 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
883#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
884 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000885 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
886 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000887 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
888 ++Idx;
889#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
890#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000891
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000892 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
893
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000894 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000895 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
896 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
897 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
898 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
899 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
900 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000901 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000902 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
903 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
904 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
905 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
906 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
907 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000908 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000909 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
910 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
911 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
912 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
913 << NumImplicitDestructors
914 << " implicit destructors created\n";
915
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000916 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000917 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000918 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
919 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000920
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000921 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000922}
923
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000924void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
925 bool NotifyListeners) {
926 if (NotifyListeners)
927 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
928 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
929
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000930 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
931 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
932 else
Richard Smith90dc5252017-06-23 01:04:34 +0000933 ND->setVisibleDespiteOwningModule();
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000934}
935
936void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
937 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
938 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
939 return;
940
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000941 auto &Merged = It->second;
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000942 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
943 for (Module *&M : Merged)
944 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
945 M = nullptr;
946 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
947}
948
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +0000949void ASTContext::PerModuleInitializers::resolve(ASTContext &Ctx) {
950 if (LazyInitializers.empty())
951 return;
952
953 auto *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
954 assert(Source && "lazy initializers but no external source");
955
956 auto LazyInits = std::move(LazyInitializers);
957 LazyInitializers.clear();
958
959 for (auto ID : LazyInits)
960 Initializers.push_back(Source->GetExternalDecl(ID));
961
962 assert(LazyInitializers.empty() &&
963 "GetExternalDecl for lazy module initializer added more inits");
964}
965
966void ASTContext::addModuleInitializer(Module *M, Decl *D) {
967 // One special case: if we add a module initializer that imports another
968 // module, and that module's only initializer is an ImportDecl, simplify.
969 if (auto *ID = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D)) {
970 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(ID->getImportedModule());
971
972 // Maybe the ImportDecl does nothing at all. (Common case.)
973 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
974 return;
975
976 // Maybe the ImportDecl only imports another ImportDecl.
977 auto &Imported = *It->second;
978 if (Imported.Initializers.size() + Imported.LazyInitializers.size() == 1) {
979 Imported.resolve(*this);
980 auto *OnlyDecl = Imported.Initializers.front();
981 if (isa<ImportDecl>(OnlyDecl))
982 D = OnlyDecl;
983 }
984 }
985
986 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
987 if (!Inits)
988 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
989 Inits->Initializers.push_back(D);
990}
991
992void ASTContext::addLazyModuleInitializers(Module *M, ArrayRef<uint32_t> IDs) {
993 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
994 if (!Inits)
995 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
996 Inits->LazyInitializers.insert(Inits->LazyInitializers.end(),
997 IDs.begin(), IDs.end());
998}
999
1000ArrayRef<Decl*> ASTContext::getModuleInitializers(Module *M) {
1001 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(M);
1002 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
1003 return None;
1004
1005 auto *Inits = It->second;
1006 Inits->resolve(*this);
1007 return Inits->Initializers;
1008}
1009
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +00001010ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
1011 if (!ExternCContext)
1012 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
1013
1014 return ExternCContext;
1015}
1016
David Majnemerd9b1a4f2015-11-04 03:40:30 +00001017BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1018ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
1019 const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
1020 auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK);
1021 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
1022 TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
1023
1024 return BuiltinTemplate;
1025}
1026
1027BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1028ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
1029 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
1030 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
1031 getMakeIntegerSeqName());
1032 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
1033}
1034
Eric Fiselier6ad68552016-07-01 01:24:09 +00001035BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1036ASTContext::getTypePackElementDecl() const {
1037 if (!TypePackElementDecl)
1038 TypePackElementDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__type_pack_element,
1039 getTypePackElementName());
1040 return TypePackElementDecl;
1041}
1042
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001043RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
1044 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001045 SourceLocation Loc;
1046 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001047 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1048 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
1049 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001050 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001051 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
1052 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001053 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +00001054 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
1055 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001056 return NewDecl;
1057}
1058
1059TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
1060 StringRef Name) const {
1061 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
1062 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
1063 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
1064 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
1065 NewDecl->setImplicit();
1066 return NewDecl;
1067}
1068
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001069TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001070 if (!Int128Decl)
1071 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001072 return Int128Decl;
1073}
1074
1075TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001076 if (!UInt128Decl)
1077 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001078 return UInt128Decl;
1079}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +00001080
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001081void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001082 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001083 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001084 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00001085}
1086
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001087void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
1088 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001089 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
1090 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001091 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001092
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001093 this->Target = &Target;
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001094 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
1095
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001096 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
1097 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +00001098 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001099
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001100 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001101 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001102
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001103 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001104 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001105 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +00001106 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +00001107 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
1108 else
1109 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001110 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001111 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
1112 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
1113 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
1114 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
1115 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001116
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001117 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001118 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
1119 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
1120 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
1121 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
1122 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001123
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001124 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001125 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
1126 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
1127 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001128
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001129 // GNU extension, __float128 for IEEE quadruple precision
1130 InitBuiltinType(Float128Ty, BuiltinType::Float128);
1131
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00001132 // C11 extension ISO/IEC TS 18661-3
1133 InitBuiltinType(Float16Ty, BuiltinType::Float16);
1134
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00001135 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1136 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
1137 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
1138
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +00001139 // C++ 3.9.1p5
1140 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1141 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1142 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1143 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1144 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1145 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1146 else {
1147 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1148 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1149 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001150
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +00001151 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1152
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001153 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1154 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1155 else // C99
1156 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1157
1158 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1159 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1160 else // C99
1161 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1162
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001163 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1164 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1165 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1166 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1167 // expressions.
1168 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001169
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00001170 // Placeholder type for functions.
1171 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1172
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001173 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1174 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1175
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001176 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1177 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1178
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001179 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1180 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1181
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001182 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1183 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1184
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001185 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1186 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1187
Alexey Bataev1a3320e2015-08-25 14:24:04 +00001188 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1189 if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
1190 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1191
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001192 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001193 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1194 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1195 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001196 Float128ComplexTy = getComplexType(Float128Ty);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001197
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001198 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001199 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1200 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001201 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001202
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00001203 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1204#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1205 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00001206#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001207
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001208 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001209 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001210 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1211 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001212 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001213 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001214
1215 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001216 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1217 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001218
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001219 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001220
1221 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001222
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001223 // void * type
Yaxun Liu39195062017-08-04 18:16:31 +00001224 if (LangOpts.OpenCLVersion >= 200) {
1225 auto Q = VoidTy.getQualifiers();
1226 Q.setAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic);
1227 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(
1228 getQualifiedType(VoidTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Q)));
1229 } else {
1230 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
1231 }
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001232
1233 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1234 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001235
1236 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1237 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001238
1239 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00001240 VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001241}
1242
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001243DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001244 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1245}
1246
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001247AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1248 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1249 if (!Result) {
1250 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1251 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1252 }
1253
1254 return *Result;
1255}
1256
1257/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001258void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001259 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1260 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1261 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1262 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1263 }
1264}
1265
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001266// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001267MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001268ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001269 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001270 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1271 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1272}
1273
1274ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1275ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1276 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1277 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1278 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1279 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001280
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001281 return Pos->second;
1282}
1283
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001284void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001285ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001286 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1287 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001288 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1289 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001290 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1291 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1292}
1293
1294void
1295ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1296 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1297 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1298 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1299 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001300}
1301
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001302FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1303 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1304 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1305 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001306 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1307 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001308 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001309
1310 return Pos->second;
1311}
1312
1313void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1314 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1315 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1316 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001317 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001318}
1319
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001320NamedDecl *
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001321ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *UUD) {
1322 auto Pos = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001323 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001324 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001325
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001326 return Pos->second;
1327}
1328
1329void
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001330ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001331 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1332 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1333 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1334 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001335 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Inst) ||
1336 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Inst) ||
1337 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Inst)) &&
1338 "instantiation did not produce a using decl");
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001339 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1340 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1341}
1342
1343UsingShadowDecl *
1344ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1345 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1346 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1347 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001348 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001349
1350 return Pos->second;
1351}
1352
1353void
1354ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1355 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1356 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1357 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001358}
1359
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001360FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1361 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1362 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1363 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001364 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001365
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001366 return Pos->second;
1367}
1368
1369void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1370 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1371 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1372 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1373 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1374 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001375
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001376 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1377}
1378
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001379ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1380ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001381 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1382 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001383 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001384 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001385 return Pos->second.begin();
1386}
1387
1388ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1389ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001390 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1391 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001392 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001393 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001394 return Pos->second.end();
1395}
1396
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001397unsigned
1398ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001399 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1400 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001401 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1402 return 0;
Chandler Carruthb1bcd5d2016-06-11 04:45:38 +00001403 return Pos->second.size();
Clement Courbet8251ebf2016-06-10 11:54:43 +00001404}
1405
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001406ASTContext::overridden_method_range
1407ASTContext::overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1408 return overridden_method_range(overridden_methods_begin(Method),
1409 overridden_methods_end(Method));
1410}
1411
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001412void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1413 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001414 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001415 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1416}
1417
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001418void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1419 const NamedDecl *D,
1420 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001421 assert(D);
1422
1423 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001424 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1425 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001426 return;
1427 }
1428
1429 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1430 if (!Method)
1431 return;
1432
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001433 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1434 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001435 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001436}
1437
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001438void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1439 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1440 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1441 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1442 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1443 LastLocalImport = Import;
1444 return;
1445 }
1446
1447 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1448 LastLocalImport = Import;
1449}
1450
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001451//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1452// Type Sizing and Analysis
1453//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001454
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001455/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1456/// scalar floating point type.
1457const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001458 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001459 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1460 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001461 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00001462 case BuiltinType::Float16:
1463 case BuiltinType::Half:
1464 return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001465 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1466 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1467 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001468 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Target->getFloat128Format();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001469 }
1470}
1471
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001472CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001473 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001474
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001475 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1476 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1477 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001478
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001479 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1480 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1481 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1482 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001483 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001484 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1485 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1486 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1487 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1488 } else {
1489 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1490 }
1491 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001492 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1493 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1494 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1495 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001496
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001497 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1498 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001499 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001500 // do nothing
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001501 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001502 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001503 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001504 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001505 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1506 else
1507 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1508 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001509 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
Akira Hatanakad62f2c82017-01-06 17:56:15 +00001510 if (T->isFunctionType())
1511 Align = getTypeInfoImpl(T.getTypePtr()).Align;
1512 else if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001513 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1514 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001515 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001516 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1517 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001518 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1519 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1520 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1521 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1522 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1523 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001524 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001525 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Roger Ferrer Ibanez3fa38a12017-03-08 14:00:44 +00001526 if (BaseT.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned())
1527 Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001528 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Ulrich Weigandb63f7792015-04-21 17:26:18 +00001529 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001530 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1531 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001532 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001533
1534 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1535 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1536 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1537 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1538 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001539 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1540 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1541 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1542 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1543 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001544
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001545 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1546 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001547
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001548 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1549 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1550 if (Offset > 0) {
1551 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1552 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1553 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1554 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1555 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1556 }
1557
1558 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001559 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001560 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001561 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001562
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001563 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001564}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001565
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001566// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1567// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1568// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1569// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1570std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1571ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1572 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1573
1574 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1575 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1576 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1577 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1578 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1579 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1580 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1581 }
1582 }
1583
1584 return sizeAndAlign;
1585}
1586
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001587/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1588/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1589std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1590static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1591 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1592 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1593 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1594 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001595 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1596 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001597 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1598 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1599 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001600 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1601 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001602 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001603 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1604 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1605}
1606
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001607std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001608ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001609 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1610 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001611 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1612 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1613 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001614}
1615
1616std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001617ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001618 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1619}
1620
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001621bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1622 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1623}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001624
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001625bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1626 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1627}
1628
Richard Smithb2f0f052016-10-10 18:54:32 +00001629unsigned ASTContext::getTypeAlignIfKnown(QualType T) const {
1630 // An alignment on a typedef overrides anything else.
1631 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1632 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1633 return Align;
1634
1635 // If we have an (array of) complete type, we're done.
1636 T = getBaseElementType(T);
1637 if (!T->isIncompleteType())
1638 return getTypeAlign(T);
1639
1640 // If we had an array type, its element type might be a typedef
1641 // type with an alignment attribute.
1642 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1643 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1644 return Align;
1645
1646 // Otherwise, see if the declaration of the type had an attribute.
1647 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TagType>())
1648 return TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment();
1649
1650 return 0;
1651}
1652
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001653TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001654 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1655 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1656 return I->second;
1657
1658 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1659 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1660 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001661 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001662}
1663
1664/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1665/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001666///
1667/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1668/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1669/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001670TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1671 uint64_t Width = 0;
1672 unsigned Align = 8;
1673 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001674 unsigned AS = 0;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001675 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001676#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1677#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001678#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001679#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001680#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1681 case Type::Class: \
1682 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1683 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001684#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001685 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001686
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001687 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1688 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001689 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1690 Width = 0;
1691 Align = 32;
1692 break;
1693
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001694 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001695 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001696 Width = 0;
1697 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1698 break;
1699
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001700 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001701 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001702
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001703 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001704 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001705 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001706 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001707 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1708 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001709 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1710 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001711 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001712 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001713 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001714 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001715 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001716 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001717 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1718 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001719 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001720 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1721 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001722 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001723 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001724 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001725 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001726 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1727 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1728 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1729 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001730 break;
1731 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001732
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001733 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001734 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001735 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001736 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001737 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1738 Width = 0;
1739 Align = 8;
1740 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001741 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001742 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1743 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001744 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001745 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1746 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1747 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001748 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001749 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1750 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001751 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001752 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1753 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001754 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1755 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001756 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001757 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001758 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1759 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001760 break;
1761 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001762 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1763 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001764 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001765 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001766 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001767 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1768 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001769 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001770 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001771 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001772 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1773 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001774 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001775 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001776 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001777 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1778 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001779 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001780 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001781 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001782 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1783 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001784 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001785 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1786 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1787 Width = 128;
1788 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1789 break;
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00001790 case BuiltinType::Float16:
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001791 case BuiltinType::Half:
1792 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1793 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1794 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001795 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001796 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1797 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001798 break;
1799 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001800 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1801 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001802 break;
1803 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001804 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1805 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001806 break;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001807 case BuiltinType::Float128:
1808 Width = Target->getFloat128Width();
1809 Align = Target->getFloat128Align();
1810 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001811 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001812 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1813 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001814 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001815 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1816 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1817 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001818 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1819 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001820 break;
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001821 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001822 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001823 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
1824 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001825 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Yaxun Liu99444cb2016-08-03 20:38:06 +00001826#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1827 case BuiltinType::Id:
1828#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Sven van Haastregt3bb7eaf2017-12-06 10:11:28 +00001829 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1830 Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T)));
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001831 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1832 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1833 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001834 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001835 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001836 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001837 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1838 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001839 break;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001840 case Type::BlockPointer:
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001841 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001842 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1843 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001844 break;
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001845 case Type::LValueReference:
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001846 case Type::RValueReference:
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001847 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1848 // the pointer route.
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001849 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001850 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1851 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001852 break;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001853 case Type::Pointer:
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001854 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001855 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1856 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001857 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001858 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001859 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00001860 CXXABI::MemberPointerInfo MPI = ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT);
1861 Width = MPI.Width;
1862 Align = MPI.Align;
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001863 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001864 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001865 case Type::Complex: {
1866 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1867 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001868 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1869 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1870 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001871 break;
1872 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001873 case Type::ObjCObject:
1874 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001875 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001876 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001877 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001878 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001879 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001880 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001881 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001882 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001883 break;
1884 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001885 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001886 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001887 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1888
1889 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001890 Width = 8;
1891 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001892 break;
1893 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001894
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001895 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1896 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1897 TypeInfo Info =
1898 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1899 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1900 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1901 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1902 }
1903 return Info;
1904 }
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001905
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001906 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001907 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1908 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001909 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001910 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001911 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001912 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001913 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001914
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001915 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001916 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1917 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001918
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00001919 case Type::Auto:
1920 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: {
1921 const DeducedType *A = cast<DeducedType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001922 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1923 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001924 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001925 }
1926
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001927 case Type::Paren:
1928 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1929
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00001930 case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
1931 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1932
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001933 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001934 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001935 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001936 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1937 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1938 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001939 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001940 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001941 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001942 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001943 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001944 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1945 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001946 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001947 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001948 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001949
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001950 case Type::Elaborated:
1951 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001952
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001953 case Type::Attributed:
1954 return getTypeInfo(
1955 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1956
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001957 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001958 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001959 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1960 Width = Info.Width;
1961 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001962
1963 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1964 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1965 // favorable to atomic operations:
1966 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1967 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1968 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1969 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1970
1971 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001972 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1973 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001974 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00001975 break;
1976
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001977 case Type::Pipe:
Anastasia Stulovab3398932017-06-05 11:27:03 +00001978 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global));
1979 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global));
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001980 break;
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001981 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001982
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001983 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001984 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001985}
1986
Alexey Bataev00396512015-07-02 03:40:19 +00001987unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1988 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1989 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1990 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1991 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1992 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1993 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1994 SimdAlign = 256;
1995 return SimdAlign;
1996}
1997
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001998/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1999CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
2000 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
2001}
2002
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00002003/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
2004int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
2005 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
2006}
2007
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00002008/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
2009/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002010CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00002011 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00002012}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002013CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00002014 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00002015}
2016
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00002017/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00002018/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002019CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00002020 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00002021}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002022CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00002023 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00002024}
2025
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00002026/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
2027/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
2028/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
2029/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002030unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00002031 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
2032 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002033
David Majnemere1544562015-04-24 01:25:05 +00002034 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
2035
2036 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
2037 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
2038 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
2039
Andrey Turetskiydb6655f2016-02-10 11:58:46 +00002040 if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment())
2041 return ABIAlign;
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00002042
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002043 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00002044 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002045 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00002046 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
2047 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002048 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00002049 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
2050 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002051 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
2052 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00002053 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002054 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002055
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00002056 return ABIAlign;
2057}
2058
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002059/// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
2060/// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
2061/// value is specified.
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00002062unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002063 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
2064}
2065
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00002066/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
2067/// to a global variable of the specified type.
2068unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
2069 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
2070}
2071
2072/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
2073/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
2074CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
2075 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
2076}
2077
David Majnemer08ef2ba2015-06-23 20:34:18 +00002078CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
2079 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
2080 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2081 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
2082 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
2083 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
2084 }
2085 return Offset;
2086}
2087
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002088/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
2089/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
2090/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
2091/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
2092/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002093void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
2094 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002095 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002096 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
2097 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
2098 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00002099 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
2100 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00002101 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002102 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002103 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002104 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
2105 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
2106 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00002107}
2108
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002109/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
2110/// those inherited by it.
2111void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00002112 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002113 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00002114 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
2115 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00002116 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002117 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00002118 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002119
2120 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00002121 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
2122 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002123
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002124 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
2125 while (SD) {
2126 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
2127 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
2128 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002129 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00002130 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002131 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002132 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002133 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002134 // Insert the protocol.
2135 if (!Protocols.insert(
2136 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
2137 return;
2138
2139 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
2140 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002141 }
2142}
2143
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00002144static bool unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2145 const RecordDecl *RD) {
2146 assert(RD->isUnion() && "Must be union type");
2147 CharUnits UnionSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(RD->getTypeForDecl());
2148
2149 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
2150 if (!Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType()))
2151 return false;
2152 CharUnits FieldSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType());
2153 if (FieldSize != UnionSize)
2154 return false;
2155 }
2156 return true;
2157}
2158
2159bool isStructEmpty(QualType Ty) {
2160 const RecordDecl *RD = Ty->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
2161
2162 if (!RD->field_empty())
2163 return false;
2164
2165 if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
2166 return ClassDecl->isEmpty();
2167
2168 return true;
2169}
2170
2171static llvm::Optional<int64_t>
2172structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2173 const RecordDecl *RD) {
2174 assert(!RD->isUnion() && "Must be struct/class type");
2175 const auto &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2176
2177 int64_t CurOffsetInBits = 0;
2178 if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
2179 if (ClassDecl->isDynamicClass())
2180 return llvm::None;
2181
2182 SmallVector<std::pair<QualType, int64_t>, 4> Bases;
2183 for (const auto Base : ClassDecl->bases()) {
2184 // Empty types can be inherited from, and non-empty types can potentially
2185 // have tail padding, so just make sure there isn't an error.
2186 if (!isStructEmpty(Base.getType())) {
2187 llvm::Optional<int64_t> Size = structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2188 Context, Base.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
2189 if (!Size)
2190 return llvm::None;
2191 Bases.emplace_back(Base.getType(), Size.getValue());
2192 }
2193 }
2194
2195 std::sort(
2196 Bases.begin(), Bases.end(), [&](const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &L,
2197 const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &R) {
2198 return Layout.getBaseClassOffset(L.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) <
2199 Layout.getBaseClassOffset(R.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl());
2200 });
2201
2202 for (const auto Base : Bases) {
2203 int64_t BaseOffset = Context.toBits(
2204 Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()));
2205 int64_t BaseSize = Base.second;
2206 if (BaseOffset != CurOffsetInBits)
2207 return llvm::None;
2208 CurOffsetInBits = BaseOffset + BaseSize;
2209 }
2210 }
2211
2212 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
2213 if (!Field->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
2214 !Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType()))
2215 return llvm::None;
2216
2217 int64_t FieldSizeInBits =
2218 Context.toBits(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType()));
2219 if (Field->isBitField()) {
2220 int64_t BitfieldSize = Field->getBitWidthValue(Context);
2221
2222 if (BitfieldSize > FieldSizeInBits)
2223 return llvm::None;
2224 FieldSizeInBits = BitfieldSize;
2225 }
2226
2227 int64_t FieldOffsetInBits = Context.getFieldOffset(Field);
2228
2229 if (FieldOffsetInBits != CurOffsetInBits)
2230 return llvm::None;
2231
2232 CurOffsetInBits = FieldSizeInBits + FieldOffsetInBits;
2233 }
2234
2235 return CurOffsetInBits;
2236}
2237
2238bool ASTContext::hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(QualType Ty) const {
2239 // C++17 [meta.unary.prop]:
2240 // The predicate condition for a template specialization
2241 // has_unique_object_representations<T> shall be
2242 // satisfied if and only if:
2243 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable, and
2244 // (9.2) - any two objects of type T with the same value have the same
2245 // object representation, where two objects
2246 // of array or non-union class type are considered to have the same value
2247 // if their respective sequences of
2248 // direct subobjects have the same values, and two objects of union type
2249 // are considered to have the same
2250 // value if they have the same active member and the corresponding members
2251 // have the same value.
2252 // The set of scalar types for which this condition holds is
2253 // implementation-defined. [ Note: If a type has padding
2254 // bits, the condition does not hold; otherwise, the condition holds true
2255 // for unsigned integral types. -- end note ]
2256 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "Null QualType sent to unique object rep check");
2257
2258 // Arrays are unique only if their element type is unique.
2259 if (Ty->isArrayType())
2260 return hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(getBaseElementType(Ty));
2261
2262 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable...
2263 if (!Ty.isTriviallyCopyableType(*this))
2264 return false;
2265
2266 // All integrals and enums are unique.
2267 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
2268 return true;
2269
2270 // All other pointers are unique.
2271 if (Ty->isPointerType())
2272 return true;
2273
2274 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
2275 const MemberPointerType *MPT = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2276 return !ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT).HasPadding;
2277 }
2278
2279 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
2280 const RecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
2281
Erich Keanebd2197c2017-12-12 16:02:06 +00002282 if (Record->isInvalidDecl())
2283 return false;
2284
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00002285 if (Record->isUnion())
2286 return unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record);
2287
2288 Optional<int64_t> StructSize =
2289 structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record);
2290
2291 return StructSize &&
2292 StructSize.getValue() == static_cast<int64_t>(getTypeSize(Ty));
2293 }
2294
2295 // FIXME: More cases to handle here (list by rsmith):
2296 // vectors (careful about, eg, vector of 3 foo)
2297 // _Complex int and friends
2298 // _Atomic T
2299 // Obj-C block pointers
2300 // Obj-C object pointers
2301 // and perhaps OpenCL's various builtin types (pipe, sampler_t, event_t,
2302 // clk_event_t, queue_t, reserve_id_t)
2303 // There're also Obj-C class types and the Obj-C selector type, but I think it
2304 // makes sense for those to return false here.
2305
2306 return false;
2307}
2308
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002309unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002310 unsigned count = 0;
2311 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00002312 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002313 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002314
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002315 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
2316 // includes synthesized ivars.
2317 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002318 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2319
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00002320 return count;
2321}
2322
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00002323bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2324 if (!E)
2325 return false;
2326
2327 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2328 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2329
2330 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2331 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2332 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2333 return true;
2334
2335 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2336 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2337
2338 return false;
2339}
2340
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002341/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl, or nullptr if none
2342/// exists.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002343ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2344 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2345 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2346 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2347 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002348 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002349}
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002350
2351/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or nullptr if none
2352/// exists.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002353ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2354 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2355 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2356 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2357 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002358 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002359}
2360
2361/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2362void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2363 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2364 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2365 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2366}
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002367
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002368/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2369void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2370 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2371 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2372 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2373}
2374
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00002375const ObjCMethodDecl *
2376ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2377 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2378}
2379
2380void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2381 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2382 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2383 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2384}
2385
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002386const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2387 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2388 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2389 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002390 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002391 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2392 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002393 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002394 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2395 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002396 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2397
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002398 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002399}
2400
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002401/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl, or nullptr if
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002402/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002403Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002404 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2405 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2406 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002407 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002408 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002409 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002410}
2411
2412/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2413void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2414 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002415 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2416 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002417 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2418}
2419
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002420TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002421 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002422 if (!DataSize)
2423 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2424 else
2425 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002426 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002427
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002428 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2429 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2430 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2431 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00002432}
2433
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002434TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00002435 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002436 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00002437 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00002438 return DI;
2439}
2440
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002441const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002442ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002443 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002444}
2445
2446const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002447ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2448 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002449 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2450}
2451
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002452//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2453// Type creation/memoization methods
2454//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2455
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002456QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002457ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2458 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2459 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002460
2461 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2462 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002463 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002464 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002465 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2466 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2467 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002468 }
2469
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002470 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2471 QualType canon;
2472 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2473 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002474 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2475 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002476
2477 // Re-find the insert position.
2478 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2479 }
2480
2481 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2482 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2483 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002484}
2485
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00002486QualType ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T,
2487 LangAS AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002488 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2489 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002490 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002491
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002492 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2493 // into one ExtQuals node.
2494 QualifierCollector Quals;
2495 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002496
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002497 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2498 // another one.
2499 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2500 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2501 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002502
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002503 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002504}
2505
Andrew Gozillon572bbb02017-10-02 06:25:51 +00002506QualType ASTContext::removeAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T) const {
2507 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2508 // into one ExtQuals node.
2509 QualifierCollector Quals;
2510 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2511
2512 // If the qualifier doesn't have an address space just return it.
2513 if (!Quals.hasAddressSpace())
2514 return T;
2515
2516 Quals.removeAddressSpace();
2517
2518 // Removal of the address space can mean there are no longer any
2519 // non-fast qualifiers, so creating an ExtQualType isn't possible (asserts)
2520 // or required.
2521 if (Quals.hasNonFastQualifiers())
2522 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2523 else
2524 return QualType(TypeNode, Quals.getFastQualifiers());
2525}
2526
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002527QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002528 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002529 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002530 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002531 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002532
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002533 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2534 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002535 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002536 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2537 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2538 }
2539 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002540
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002541 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2542 // into one ExtQuals node.
2543 QualifierCollector Quals;
2544 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002545
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002546 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2547 // another one.
2548 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2549 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2550 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002551
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002552 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002553}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002554
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002555const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2556 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2557 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2558 return T;
2559
2560 QualType Result;
2561 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002562 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002563 } else {
2564 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2565 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2566 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002567 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002568 }
2569
2570 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2571}
2572
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002573void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2574 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002575 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2576 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002577 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2578 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002579 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002580 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2581 FD = Next;
2582 else
2583 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002584 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002585 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2586 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002587}
2588
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002589/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2590/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2591/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2592/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2593static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2594 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2595 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2596 // Might have some parens.
2597 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2598 return Context.getParenType(
2599 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2600
2601 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2602 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2603 return Context.getAttributedType(
2604 AT->getAttrKind(),
2605 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2606 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2607 ESI));
2608
2609 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2610 // specification.
2611 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2612 return Context.getFunctionType(
2613 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2614 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2615}
2616
Richard Smithdfe85e22016-12-15 02:35:39 +00002617bool ASTContext::hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(QualType T,
2618 QualType U) {
2619 return hasSameType(T, U) ||
Aaron Ballmanc351fba2017-12-04 20:27:34 +00002620 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
Richard Smithdfe85e22016-12-15 02:35:39 +00002621 hasSameType(getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, T, EST_None),
2622 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, U, EST_None)));
2623}
2624
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002625void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2626 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2627 bool AsWritten) {
2628 // Update the type.
2629 QualType Updated =
2630 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2631 FD->setType(Updated);
2632
2633 if (!AsWritten)
2634 return;
2635
2636 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2637 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2638 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2639 // the type-as-written too.
2640 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2641 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2642
2643 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2644 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2645 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2646 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2647 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2648 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2649 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2650 }
2651}
2652
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002653/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2654/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002655QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002656 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2657 // structure.
2658 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2659 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002660
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002661 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002662 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2663 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002664
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002665 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2666 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2667 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002668 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002669 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002670
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002671 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2672 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002673 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002674 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002675 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002676 Types.push_back(New);
2677 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2678 return QualType(New, 0);
2679}
2680
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002681/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2682/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002683QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002684 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2685 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002686 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002687 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002688
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002689 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002690 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002691 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002692
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002693 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2694 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002695 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002696 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002697 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002698
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002699 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2700 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002701 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002702 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002703 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002704 Types.push_back(New);
2705 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002706 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002707}
2708
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002709QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2710 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2711 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002712 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002713 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2714 if (AT)
2715 return QualType(AT, 0);
2716
2717 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2718
2719 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2720 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002721 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002722
2723 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2724 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2725 Types.push_back(AT);
2726 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2727 return QualType(AT, 0);
2728}
2729
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002730QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2731 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2732
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002733 QualType Decayed;
2734
2735 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2736 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2737 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2738 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2739 // the array type derivation.
2740 if (T->isArrayType())
2741 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2742
2743 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2744 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2745 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2746 // in 6.3.2.1.
2747 if (T->isFunctionType())
2748 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2749
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002750 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2751 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002752 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002753 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2754 if (AT)
2755 return QualType(AT, 0);
2756
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002757 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2758
2759 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002760 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002761 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002762
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002763 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2764 Types.push_back(AT);
2765 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2766 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002767}
2768
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002769/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002770/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002771QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002772 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2773 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002774 // structure.
2775 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2776 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002777
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002778 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002779 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2780 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2781 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002782
2783 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002784 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2785 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002786 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002787 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002788
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002789 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2790 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2791 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002792 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002793 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002794 BlockPointerType *New
2795 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002796 Types.push_back(New);
2797 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2798 return QualType(New, 0);
2799}
2800
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002801/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2802/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002803QualType
2804ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002805 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2806 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2807
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002808 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2809 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002810 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002811 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002812
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002813 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002814 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2815 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002816 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002817
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002818 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2819
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002820 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2821 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2822 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002823 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2824 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2825 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002826
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002827 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002828 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2829 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002830 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002831 }
2832
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002833 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002834 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2835 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002836 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002837 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002838
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002839 return QualType(New, 0);
2840}
2841
2842/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2843/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002844QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002845 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2846 // structure.
2847 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002848 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002849
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002850 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002851 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2852 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2853 return QualType(RT, 0);
2854
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002855 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2856
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002857 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2858 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2859 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002860 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2861 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2862 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002863
2864 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2865 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2866 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002867 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002868 }
2869
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002870 RValueReferenceType *New
2871 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002872 Types.push_back(New);
2873 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002874 return QualType(New, 0);
2875}
2876
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002877/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2878/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002879QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002880 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2881 // structure.
2882 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2883 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2884
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002885 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002886 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2887 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2888 return QualType(PT, 0);
2889
2890 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2891 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2892 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002893 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002894 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2895
2896 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2897 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2898 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002899 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002900 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002901 MemberPointerType *New
2902 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002903 Types.push_back(New);
2904 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2905 return QualType(New, 0);
2906}
2907
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002908/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002909/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002910QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002911 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002912 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002913 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002914 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2915 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002916 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2917
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002918 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2919 // the target.
2920 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Konstantin Zhuravlyov9c1e3102017-03-21 18:55:39 +00002921 ArySize = ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getMaxPointerWidth());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002922
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002923 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002924 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002925
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002926 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002927 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002928 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002929 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002930
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002931 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2932 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2933 QualType Canon;
2934 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2935 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002936 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002937 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002938 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002939
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002940 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002941 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002942 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002943 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002944 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002945
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002946 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002947 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002948 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002949 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002950 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002951}
2952
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002953/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2954/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2955/// sizes replaced with [*].
2956QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2957 // Vastly most common case.
2958 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002959
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002960 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002961
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002962 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002963 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002964 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2965#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2966#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2967#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2968#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2969 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2970
2971 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2972 case Type::Builtin:
2973 case Type::Complex:
2974 case Type::Vector:
2975 case Type::ExtVector:
2976 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
Andrew Gozillon572bbb02017-10-02 06:25:51 +00002977 case Type::DependentAddressSpace:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002978 case Type::ObjCObject:
2979 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2980 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2981 case Type::Record:
2982 case Type::Enum:
2983 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2984 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2985 case Type::TypeOf:
2986 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002987 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002988 case Type::DependentName:
2989 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2990 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2991 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2992 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2993 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002994 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00002995 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002996 case Type::PackExpansion:
2997 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2998
2999 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
3000 // further decay.
3001 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
3002 case Type::FunctionProto:
3003 case Type::BlockPointer:
3004 case Type::MemberPointer:
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003005 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003006 return type;
3007
3008 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
3009 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
3010 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
3011 // optimizations available here.
3012 case Type::Pointer:
3013 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
3014 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
3015 break;
3016
3017 case Type::LValueReference: {
3018 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
3019 result = getLValueReferenceType(
3020 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
3021 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
3022 break;
3023 }
3024
3025 case Type::RValueReference: {
3026 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
3027 result = getRValueReferenceType(
3028 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
3029 break;
3030 }
3031
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003032 case Type::Atomic: {
3033 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
3034 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
3035 break;
3036 }
3037
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003038 case Type::ConstantArray: {
3039 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
3040 result = getConstantArrayType(
3041 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
3042 cat->getSize(),
3043 cat->getSizeModifier(),
3044 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
3045 break;
3046 }
3047
3048 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
3049 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
3050 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
3051 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
3052 dat->getSizeExpr(),
3053 dat->getSizeModifier(),
3054 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3055 dat->getBracketsRange());
3056 break;
3057 }
3058
3059 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
3060 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
3061 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
3062 result = getVariableArrayType(
3063 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003064 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003065 ArrayType::Normal,
3066 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3067 SourceRange());
3068 break;
3069 }
3070
3071 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
3072 case Type::VariableArray: {
3073 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
3074 result = getVariableArrayType(
3075 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003076 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003077 ArrayType::Star,
3078 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3079 vat->getBracketsRange());
3080 break;
3081 }
3082 }
3083
3084 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003085 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003086}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003087
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00003088/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
3089/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00003090QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
3091 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00003092 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00003093 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003094 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003095 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
3096 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003097 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00003098
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003099 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
3100 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
3101 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003102 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00003103 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003104 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00003105 }
3106
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003107 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00003108 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003109
3110 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
3111 Types.push_back(New);
3112 return QualType(New, 0);
3113}
3114
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003115/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
3116/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00003117/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003118QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
3119 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003120 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003121 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
3122 SourceRange brackets) const {
3123 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
3124 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003125 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
3126
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003127 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
3128 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
3129 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
3130 // because they can't be used in most locations.
3131 if (!numElements) {
3132 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
3133 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3134 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
3135 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
3136 brackets);
3137 Types.push_back(newType);
3138 return QualType(newType, 0);
3139 }
3140
3141 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
3142 // also build a canonical type.
3143
3144 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
3145
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003146 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003147 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003148 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003149 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003150 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00003151
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003152 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
3153 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
3154 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00003155
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003156 // If we don't have one, build one.
3157 if (!canonTy) {
3158 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003159 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003160 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
3161 brackets);
3162 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
3163 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00003164 }
3165
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003166 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
3167 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003168 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003169
David Majnemer16a74702015-07-24 05:54:19 +00003170 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
3171 // expression, then just use that as our result.
3172 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
3173 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003174 return canon;
3175
3176 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
3177 // of the element type.
3178 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
3179 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3180 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
3181 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
3182 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
3183 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003184}
3185
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003186QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003187 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003188 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003189 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003190 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003191
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003192 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003193 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
3194 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
3195 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003196
3197 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003198 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
3199 // qualifiers off the element type.
3200 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003201
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003202 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
3203 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003204 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003205 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003206 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003207
3208 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003209 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
3210 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
3211 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00003212 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003213
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003214 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3215 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003216
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003217 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
3218 Types.push_back(newType);
3219 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00003220}
3221
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003222/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
3223/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00003224QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003225 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003226 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003227
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003228 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3229 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003230 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00003231
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003232 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003233 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3234 return QualType(VTP, 0);
3235
3236 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3237 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3238 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00003239 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00003240 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003241
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003242 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3243 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003244 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003245 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003246 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003247 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003248 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3249 Types.push_back(New);
3250 return QualType(New, 0);
3251}
3252
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003253/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003254/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003255QualType
3256ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00003257 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003258
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003259 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3260 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00003261 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003262 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003263 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003264 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3265 return QualType(VTP, 0);
3266
3267 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3268 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3269 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003270 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003271 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003272
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003273 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3274 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003275 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003276 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003277 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3278 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003279 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3280 Types.push_back(New);
3281 return QualType(New, 0);
3282}
3283
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003284QualType
3285ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
3286 Expr *SizeExpr,
3287 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003288 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003289 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003290 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003291
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003292 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003293 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
3294 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3295 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
3296 if (Canon) {
3297 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
3298 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003299 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3300 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
3301 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003302 } else {
3303 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
3304 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003305 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3306 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
3307 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003308
3309 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
3310 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3311 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
3312 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003313 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3314 } else {
3315 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
3316 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003317 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3318 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003319 }
3320 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003321
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00003322 Types.push_back(New);
3323 return QualType(New, 0);
3324}
3325
Andrew Gozillon572bbb02017-10-02 06:25:51 +00003326QualType ASTContext::getDependentAddressSpaceType(QualType PointeeType,
3327 Expr *AddrSpaceExpr,
3328 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
3329 assert(AddrSpaceExpr->isInstantiationDependent());
3330
3331 QualType canonPointeeType = getCanonicalType(PointeeType);
3332
3333 void *insertPos = nullptr;
3334 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3335 DependentAddressSpaceType::Profile(ID, *this, canonPointeeType,
3336 AddrSpaceExpr);
3337
3338 DependentAddressSpaceType *canonTy =
3339 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
3340
3341 if (!canonTy) {
3342 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3343 DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, canonPointeeType,
3344 QualType(), AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc);
3345 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
3346 Types.push_back(canonTy);
3347 }
3348
3349 if (canonPointeeType == PointeeType &&
3350 canonTy->getAddrSpaceExpr() == AddrSpaceExpr)
3351 return QualType(canonTy, 0);
3352
3353 DependentAddressSpaceType *sugaredType
3354 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3355 DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, PointeeType, QualType(canonTy, 0),
3356 AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc);
3357 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
3358 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
3359}
3360
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003361/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
3362static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
3363 return T.isCanonical() &&
3364 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
3365 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
3366}
3367
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003368/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003369QualType
3370ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
3371 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003372 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3373 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003374 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00003375 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003376
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003377 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003378 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003379 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003380 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003381
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003382 QualType Canonical;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003383 if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) {
3384 Canonical =
3385 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003386
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003387 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003388 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
3389 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003390 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003391 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003392
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003393 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003394 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003395 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003396 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003397 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003398}
3399
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003400CanQualType
3401ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
3402 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
3403
3404 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3405 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3406 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
3407 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3408 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
3409 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
3410 }
3411
3412 return CanResultType;
3413}
3414
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003415static bool isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(
3416 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, bool NoexceptInType) {
3417 if (ESI.Type == EST_None)
3418 return true;
3419 if (!NoexceptInType)
3420 return false;
3421
3422 // C++17 onwards: exception specification is part of the type, as a simple
3423 // boolean "can this function type throw".
3424 if (ESI.Type == EST_BasicNoexcept)
3425 return true;
3426
3427 // A dynamic exception specification is canonical if it only contains pack
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003428 // expansions (so we can't tell whether it's non-throwing) and all its
3429 // contained types are canonical.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003430 if (ESI.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
Richard Smithfda59e52016-10-26 01:05:54 +00003431 bool AnyPackExpansions = false;
3432 for (QualType ET : ESI.Exceptions) {
3433 if (!ET.isCanonical())
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003434 return false;
Richard Smithfda59e52016-10-26 01:05:54 +00003435 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
3436 AnyPackExpansions = true;
3437 }
3438 return AnyPackExpansions;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003439 }
3440
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003441 // A noexcept(expr) specification is (possibly) canonical if expr is
3442 // value-dependent.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003443 if (ESI.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept)
3444 return ESI.NoexceptExpr && ESI.NoexceptExpr->isValueDependent();
3445
3446 return false;
3447}
3448
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003449QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeInternal(
3450 QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
3451 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI, bool OnlyWantCanonical) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003452 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
3453
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003454 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3455 // structure.
3456 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3457 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
3458 *this, true);
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003459
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003460 QualType Canonical;
3461 bool Unique = false;
3462
3463 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3464 if (FunctionProtoType *FPT =
3465 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) {
3466 QualType Existing = QualType(FPT, 0);
3467
3468 // If we find a pre-existing equivalent FunctionProtoType, we can just reuse
3469 // it so long as our exception specification doesn't contain a dependent
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003470 // noexcept expression, or we're just looking for a canonical type.
3471 // Otherwise, we're going to need to create a type
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003472 // sugar node to hold the concrete expression.
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003473 if (OnlyWantCanonical || EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type != EST_ComputedNoexcept ||
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003474 EPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr == FPT->getNoexceptExpr())
3475 return Existing;
3476
3477 // We need a new type sugar node for this one, to hold the new noexcept
3478 // expression. We do no canonicalization here, but that's OK since we don't
3479 // expect to see the same noexcept expression much more than once.
3480 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Existing);
3481 Unique = true;
3482 }
3483
Aaron Ballmanc351fba2017-12-04 20:27:34 +00003484 bool NoexceptInType = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003485 bool IsCanonicalExceptionSpec =
3486 isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(EPI.ExceptionSpec, NoexceptInType);
3487
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003488 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003489 bool isCanonical = !Unique && IsCanonicalExceptionSpec &&
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003490 isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) && !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003491 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003492 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003493 isCanonical = false;
3494
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003495 if (OnlyWantCanonical)
3496 assert(isCanonical &&
3497 "given non-canonical parameters constructing canonical type");
3498
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003499 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it if we don't
3500 // already have it. The exception spec is only partially part of the
3501 // canonical type, and only in C++17 onwards.
3502 if (!isCanonical && Canonical.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003503 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003504 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3505 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003506 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003507
Benjamin Kramer3f515cd2016-10-26 12:51:45 +00003508 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ExceptionTypeStorage;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003509 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003510 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003511
3512 if (IsCanonicalExceptionSpec) {
3513 // Exception spec is already OK.
3514 } else if (NoexceptInType) {
3515 switch (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) {
3516 case EST_Unparsed: case EST_Unevaluated: case EST_Uninstantiated:
3517 // We don't know yet. It shouldn't matter what we pick here; no-one
3518 // should ever look at this.
3519 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003520 case EST_None: case EST_MSAny:
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003521 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3522 break;
3523
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003524 // A dynamic exception specification is almost always "not noexcept",
3525 // with the exception that a pack expansion might expand to no types.
3526 case EST_Dynamic: {
3527 bool AnyPacks = false;
3528 for (QualType ET : EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions) {
3529 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
3530 AnyPacks = true;
3531 ExceptionTypeStorage.push_back(getCanonicalType(ET));
3532 }
3533 if (!AnyPacks)
3534 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3535 else {
3536 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_Dynamic;
3537 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions = ExceptionTypeStorage;
3538 }
3539 break;
3540 }
3541
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003542 case EST_DynamicNone: case EST_BasicNoexcept:
3543 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_BasicNoexcept;
3544 break;
3545
3546 case EST_ComputedNoexcept:
3547 llvm::APSInt Value(1);
3548 auto *E = CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr;
3549 if (!E || !E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Value, *this, nullptr,
3550 /*IsEvaluated*/false)) {
3551 // This noexcept specification is invalid.
3552 // FIXME: Should this be able to happen?
3553 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3554 break;
3555 }
3556
3557 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
3558 Value.getBoolValue() ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_None;
3559 break;
3560 }
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003561 } else {
3562 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
3563 }
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003564
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003565 // Adjust the canonical function result type.
3566 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003567 Canonical =
3568 getFunctionTypeInternal(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI, true);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003569
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003570 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003571 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3572 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003573 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003574 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003575
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003576 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3577 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3578 // - parameter types
3579 // - exception types
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003580 // - extended parameter information
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003581 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003582 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3583 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003584 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003585 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003586
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003587 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3588 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3589 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00003590 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003591 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00003592 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003593 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003594 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003595 }
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003596
3597 // Put the ExtParameterInfos last. If all were equal, it would make
3598 // more sense to put these before the exception specification, because
3599 // it's much easier to skip past them compared to the elaborate switch
3600 // required to skip the exception specification. However, all is not
3601 // equal; ExtParameterInfos are used to model very uncommon features,
3602 // and it's better not to burden the more common paths.
3603 if (EPI.ExtParameterInfos) {
3604 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo);
3605 }
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003606
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003607 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003608 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003609 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003610 Types.push_back(FTP);
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003611 if (!Unique)
3612 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003613 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003614}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00003615
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003616QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T, bool ReadOnly) const {
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003617 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003618 PipeType::Profile(ID, T, ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003619
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00003620 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003621 if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003622 return QualType(PT, 0);
3623
3624 // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3625 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3626 QualType Canonical;
3627 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003628 Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T), ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003629
3630 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003631 PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003632 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3633 (void)NewIP;
3634 }
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003635 PipeType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PipeType(T, Canonical, ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003636 Types.push_back(New);
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003637 PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00003638 return QualType(New, 0);
3639}
3640
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003641QualType ASTContext::getReadPipeType(QualType T) const {
3642 return getPipeType(T, true);
3643}
3644
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00003645QualType ASTContext::getWritePipeType(QualType T) const {
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003646 return getPipeType(T, false);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003647}
3648
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003649#ifndef NDEBUG
3650static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3651 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3652 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3653 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3654 return true;
3655 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3656 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3657 return true;
3658 return false;
3659}
3660#endif
3661
3662/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3663/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3664QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003665 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003666 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3667 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3668 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003669 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003670 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3671 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3672 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3673 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003674 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003675 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003676 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3677 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003678 }
3679 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3680}
3681
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003682/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3683/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003684QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003685 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003686 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003687
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003688 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003689 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003690
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003691 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3692 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3693
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003694 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003695 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003696 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003697 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003698 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003699 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003700 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003701 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003702 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003703 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3704 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3705 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003706 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003707 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003708
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003709 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003710}
3711
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003712/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003713/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003714QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003715ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3716 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003717 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003718
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003719 if (Canonical.isNull())
3720 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003721 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003722 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003723 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3724 Types.push_back(newType);
3725 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003726}
3727
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003728QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003729 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3730
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003731 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003732 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3733 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3734
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003735 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3736 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3737 Types.push_back(newType);
3738 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003739}
3740
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003741QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003742 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3743
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003744 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003745 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3746 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3747
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003748 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3749 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3750 Types.push_back(newType);
3751 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003752}
3753
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003754QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3755 QualType modifiedType,
3756 QualType equivalentType) {
3757 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3758 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3759
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003760 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003761 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3762 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3763
3764 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3765 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3766 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3767
3768 Types.push_back(type);
3769 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3770
3771 return QualType(type, 0);
3772}
3773
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003774/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3775QualType
3776ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003777 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003778 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003779 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3780
3781 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3782 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003783 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003784 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3785 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3786
3787 if (!SubstParm) {
3788 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3789 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3790 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3791 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3792 }
3793
3794 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3795}
3796
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003797/// \brief Retrieve a
3798QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3799 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3800 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3801#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003802 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3803 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3804 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003805 }
3806#endif
3807
3808 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3809 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003810 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003811 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3812 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3813 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3814
3815 QualType Canon;
3816 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3817 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3818 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3819 ArgPack);
3820 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3821 }
3822
3823 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3824 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3825 ArgPack);
3826 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
George Burgess IVb5fe8552017-06-12 17:44:30 +00003827 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003828 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3829}
3830
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003831/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003832/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003833/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003834QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003835 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003836 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003837 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003838 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003839 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003840 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003841 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3842
3843 if (TypeParm)
3844 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003845
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003846 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003847 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003848 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003849
3850 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3851 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3852 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3853 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003854 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003855 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3856 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003857
3858 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3859 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3860
3861 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3862}
3863
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003864TypeSourceInfo *
3865ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3866 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3867 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003868 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003869 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3870 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003871 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003872
3873 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003874 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3875 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003876 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003877 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3878 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3879 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3880 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3881 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3882 return DI;
3883}
3884
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003885QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003886ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003887 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003888 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003889 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3890 "No dependent template names here!");
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003891
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003892 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003893 ArgVec.reserve(Args.size());
3894 for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : Args.arguments())
3895 ArgVec.push_back(Arg.getArgument());
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003896
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003897 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec, Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003898}
3899
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003900#ifndef NDEBUG
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003901static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) {
3902 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3903 if (Arg.isPackExpansion())
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003904 return true;
3905
3906 return true;
3907}
3908#endif
3909
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003910QualType
3911ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003912 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003913 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003914 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3915 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003916 // Look through qualified template names.
3917 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3918 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003919
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003920 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003921 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3922 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003923 QualType CanonType;
3924 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3925 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3926 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003927 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3928 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003929 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args)) &&
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003930 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3931 IsTypeAlias = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003932 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args);
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003933 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003934
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003935 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3936 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3937 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003938 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003939 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size() +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003940 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003941 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003942 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003943 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, CanonType,
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003944 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003945
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003946 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003947 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003948}
3949
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003950QualType ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(
3951 TemplateName Template, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003952 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3953 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003954
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003955 // Look through qualified template names.
3956 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3957 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003958
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003959 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3960 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003961 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003962 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003963 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003964 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3965 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Arg));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003966
3967 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3968 // exists.
3969 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3970 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003971 CanonArgs, *this);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003972
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003973 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003974 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3975 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3976
3977 if (!Spec) {
3978 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3979 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3980 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3981 TypeAlignment);
3982 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003983 CanonArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003984 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003985 Types.push_back(Spec);
3986 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3987 }
3988
3989 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3990 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3991 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3992}
3993
3994QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003995ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3996 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003997 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003998 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003999 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00004000
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004001 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00004002 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00004003 if (T)
4004 return QualType(T, 0);
4005
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004006 QualType Canon = NamedType;
4007 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
4008 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00004009 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4010 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004011 (void)CheckT;
4012 }
4013
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004014 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00004015 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00004016 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00004017 return QualType(T, 0);
4018}
4019
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004020QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004021ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004022 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4023 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
4024
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004025 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004026 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4027 if (T)
4028 return QualType(T, 0);
4029
4030 QualType Canon = InnerType;
4031 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
4032 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
4033 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4034 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
4035 (void)CheckT;
4036 }
4037
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004038 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004039 Types.push_back(T);
4040 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4041 return QualType(T, 0);
4042}
4043
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00004044QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4045 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4046 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004047 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004048 if (Canon.isNull()) {
4049 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Richard Smith74f02342017-01-19 21:00:13 +00004050 if (CanonNNS != NNS)
4051 Canon = getDependentNameType(Keyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004052 }
4053
4054 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00004055 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004056
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004057 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00004058 DependentNameType *T
4059 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004060 if (T)
4061 return QualType(T, 0);
4062
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004063 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004064 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00004065 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004066 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004067}
4068
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004069QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004070ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
4071 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00004072 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004073 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004074 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004075 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00004076 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004077 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
4078 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004079 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, ArgCopy);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004080}
4081
4082QualType
4083ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
4084 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4085 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4086 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004087 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00004088 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
4089 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004090
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004091 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004092 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004093 Name, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004094
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004095 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004096 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
4097 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004098 if (T)
4099 return QualType(T, 0);
4100
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004101 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004102
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004103 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
4104 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
4105
4106 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004107 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00004108 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004109 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
4110 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
4111 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
4112 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004113 }
4114
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004115 QualType Canon;
4116 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
4117 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004118 Name,
4119 CanonArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004120
4121 // Find the insert position again.
4122 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4123 }
4124
4125 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
4126 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
4127 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00004128 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004129 Name, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004130 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004131 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004132 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004133}
4134
Richard Smith32918772017-02-14 00:25:28 +00004135TemplateArgument ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArg(NamedDecl *Param) {
4136 TemplateArgument Arg;
4137 if (auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Param)) {
4138 QualType ArgType = getTypeDeclType(TTP);
4139 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
4140 ArgType = getPackExpansionType(ArgType, None);
4141
4142 Arg = TemplateArgument(ArgType);
4143 } else if (auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Param)) {
4144 Expr *E = new (*this) DeclRefExpr(
4145 NTTP, /*enclosing*/false,
4146 NTTP->getType().getNonLValueExprType(*this),
4147 Expr::getValueKindForType(NTTP->getType()), NTTP->getLocation());
4148
4149 if (NTTP->isParameterPack())
4150 E = new (*this) PackExpansionExpr(DependentTy, E, NTTP->getLocation(),
4151 None);
4152 Arg = TemplateArgument(E);
4153 } else {
4154 auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Param);
4155 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
4156 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP), Optional<unsigned>());
4157 else
4158 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP));
4159 }
4160
4161 if (Param->isTemplateParameterPack())
4162 Arg = TemplateArgument::CreatePackCopy(*this, Arg);
4163
4164 return Arg;
4165}
4166
Richard Smith43e14d22016-12-23 02:10:11 +00004167void
4168ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArgs(const TemplateParameterList *Params,
4169 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &Args) {
4170 Args.reserve(Args.size() + Params->size());
4171
Richard Smith32918772017-02-14 00:25:28 +00004172 for (NamedDecl *Param : *Params)
4173 Args.push_back(getInjectedTemplateArg(Param));
Richard Smith43e14d22016-12-23 02:10:11 +00004174}
4175
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00004176QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00004177 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004178 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00004179 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004180
4181 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
4182 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004183 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004184 PackExpansionType *T
4185 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4186 if (T)
4187 return QualType(T, 0);
4188
4189 QualType Canon;
4190 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00004191 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
4192 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
4193 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
4194 // parameters.
4195 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00004196 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004197
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00004198 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
4199 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
4200 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4201 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004202 }
4203
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004204 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4205 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004206 Types.push_back(T);
4207 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00004208 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004209}
4210
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004211/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
4212/// alphabetically.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00004213static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
4214 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
4215 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004216}
4217
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004218static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) {
4219 if (Protocols.empty()) return true;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004220
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00004221 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
4222 return false;
4223
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004224 for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i)
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00004225 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00004226 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004227 return false;
4228 return true;
4229}
4230
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004231static void
4232SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004233 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004234 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004235
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00004236 // Canonicalize.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004237 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
4238 P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
4239
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004240 // Remove duplicates.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004241 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
4242 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004243}
4244
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004245QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
4246 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004247 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004248 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, {},
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004249 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
4250 /*isKindOf=*/false);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004251}
4252
4253QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
4254 QualType baseType,
4255 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004256 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
4257 bool isKindOf) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004258 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
4259 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004260 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
4261 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004262 return baseType;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004263
4264 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004265 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004266 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004267 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004268 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4269 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004270
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004271 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
4272 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
4273 // type.
4274 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
4275 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
4276 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
4277 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
4278 }
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004279
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004280 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
4281 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
4282 // canonicalized.
4283 QualType canonical;
4284 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
4285 effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
4286 [&](QualType type) {
4287 return type.isCanonical();
4288 });
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004289 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004290 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
4291 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
4292 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
4293 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
4294 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
4295 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
4296 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
4297 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
4298 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004299 } else {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004300 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004301 }
4302
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004303 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
4304 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
4305 if (!protocolsSorted) {
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004306 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
4307 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
4308 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004309 } else {
4310 canonProtocols = protocols;
4311 }
4312
4313 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004314 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004315
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004316 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004317 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4318 }
4319
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004320 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
4321 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
4322 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4323 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004324 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004325 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
4326 isKindOf);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004327
4328 Types.push_back(T);
4329 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4330 return QualType(T, 0);
4331}
4332
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004333/// Apply Objective-C protocol qualifiers to the given type.
4334/// If this is for the canonical type of a type parameter, we can apply
4335/// protocol qualifiers on the ObjCObjectPointerType.
4336QualType
4337ASTContext::applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(QualType type,
4338 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, bool &hasError,
4339 bool allowOnPointerType) const {
4340 hasError = false;
4341
Manman Renc5705ba2016-09-13 17:41:05 +00004342 if (const ObjCTypeParamType *objT =
4343 dyn_cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4344 return getObjCTypeParamType(objT->getDecl(), protocols);
4345 }
4346
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004347 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectPointerType.
4348 if (allowOnPointerType) {
4349 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr =
4350 dyn_cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4351 const ObjCObjectType *objT = objPtr->getObjectType();
4352 // Merge protocol lists and construct ObjCObjectType.
4353 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> protocolsVec;
4354 protocolsVec.append(objT->qual_begin(),
4355 objT->qual_end());
4356 protocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
4357 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols = protocolsVec;
4358 type = getObjCObjectType(
4359 objT->getBaseType(),
4360 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4361 protocols,
4362 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4363 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4364 }
4365 }
4366
4367 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectType.
4368 if (const ObjCObjectType *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCObjectType>(type.getTypePtr())){
4369 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4370 // known to conform.
4371
4372 return getObjCObjectType(objT->getBaseType(),
4373 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4374 protocols,
4375 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4376 }
4377
4378 // If the canonical type is ObjCObjectType, ...
4379 if (type->isObjCObjectType()) {
4380 // Silently overwrite any existing protocol qualifiers.
4381 // TODO: determine whether that's the right thing to do.
4382
4383 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4384 // known to conform.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004385 return getObjCObjectType(type, {}, protocols, false);
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004386 }
4387
4388 // id<protocol-list>
4389 if (type->isObjCIdType()) {
4390 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004391 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, protocols,
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004392 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4393 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4394 }
4395
4396 // Class<protocol-list>
4397 if (type->isObjCClassType()) {
4398 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004399 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, protocols,
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004400 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4401 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4402 }
4403
4404 hasError = true;
4405 return type;
4406}
4407
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00004408QualType
4409ASTContext::getObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Decl,
4410 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
4411 QualType Canonical) const {
4412 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4413 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4414 ObjCTypeParamType::Profile(ID, Decl, protocols);
4415 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4416 if (ObjCTypeParamType *TypeParam =
4417 ObjCTypeParamTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4418 return QualType(TypeParam, 0);
4419
4420 if (Canonical.isNull()) {
4421 // We canonicalize to the underlying type.
4422 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
4423 if (!protocols.empty()) {
4424 // Apply the protocol qualifers.
4425 bool hasError;
4426 Canonical = applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(Canonical, protocols, hasError,
4427 true/*allowOnPointerType*/);
4428 assert(!hasError && "Error when apply protocol qualifier to bound type");
4429 }
4430 }
4431
4432 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCTypeParamType);
4433 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4434 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
4435 ObjCTypeParamType *newType = new (mem)
4436 ObjCTypeParamType(Decl, Canonical, protocols);
4437
4438 Types.push_back(newType);
4439 ObjCTypeParamTypes.InsertNode(newType, InsertPos);
4440 return QualType(newType, 0);
4441}
4442
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004443/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
4444/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
4445/// list.
4446bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
4447 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
4448 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4449 return false;
4450
4451 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
4452 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004453 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004454 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
4455 return false;
4456 }
4457 return true;
4458 }
4459 return false;
4460}
4461
4462/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
4463/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
4464/// of protocols.
4465bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
4466 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
4467 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4468 return false;
4469 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4470 if (!OPT)
4471 return false;
4472 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
4473 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004474 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
4475 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
4476 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
4477 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004478 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
4479 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
4480 bool Conforms = false;
4481 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
4482 Conforms = false;
4483 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
4484 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
4485 Conforms = true;
4486 break;
4487 }
4488 }
4489 if (!Conforms)
4490 break;
4491 }
4492 if (Conforms)
4493 return true;
4494
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004495 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004496 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
4497 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004498 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004499 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004500 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004501 break;
4502 }
4503 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004504 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004505 }
4506 return true;
4507}
4508
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004509/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
4510/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004511QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004512 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4513 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
4514
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004515 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004516 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
4517 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4518 return QualType(QT, 0);
4519
4520 // Find the canonical object type.
4521 QualType Canonical;
4522 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
4523 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
4524
4525 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004526 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4527 }
4528
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00004529 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004530 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
4531 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
4532 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004533
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004534 Types.push_back(QType);
4535 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004536 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004537}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004538
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004539/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4540/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004541QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
4542 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004543 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
4544 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004545
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004546 if (PrevDecl) {
4547 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
4548 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
4549 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4550 }
4551
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00004552 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
4553 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
4554 Decl = Def;
4555
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004556 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
4557 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
4558 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
4559 Types.push_back(T);
4560 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00004561}
4562
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004563/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
4564/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004565/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004566/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004567/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004568QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004569 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004570 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
4571 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4572 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004573
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004574 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004575 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
4576 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4577 if (Canon) {
4578 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
4579 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004580 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004581 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00004582 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004583 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004584 Canon
4585 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004586 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4587 toe = Canon;
4588 }
4589 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004590 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004591 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004592 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004593 Types.push_back(toe);
4594 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004595}
4596
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004597/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004598/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004599/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004600/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
4601/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004602QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004603 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004604 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004605 Types.push_back(tot);
4606 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004607}
4608
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004609/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
4610/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
4611/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
4612/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00004613QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004614 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004615
4616 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004617 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004618 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
4619 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004620 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004621 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4622 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004623
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004624 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004625 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
4626 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004627 if (!Canon) {
Yaron Keren633e14a2016-11-29 10:08:20 +00004628 // Build a new, canonical decltype(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004629 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004630 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004631 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004632 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4633 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004634 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004635 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4636 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004637 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00004638 Types.push_back(dt);
4639 return QualType(dt, 0);
4640}
4641
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004642/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
4643/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
4644QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
4645 QualType UnderlyingType,
4646 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
4647 const {
Vassil Vassilevbab6f962016-03-30 22:18:29 +00004648 UnaryTransformType *ut = nullptr;
4649
4650 if (BaseType->isDependentType()) {
4651 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4652 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4653 DependentUnaryTransformType::Profile(ID, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind);
4654
4655 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4656 DependentUnaryTransformType *Canon
4657 = DependentUnaryTransformTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4658
4659 if (!Canon) {
4660 // Build a new, canonical __underlying_type(type) type.
4661 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4662 DependentUnaryTransformType(*this, getCanonicalType(BaseType),
4663 Kind);
4664 DependentUnaryTransformTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4665 }
4666 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4667 QualType(), Kind,
4668 QualType(Canon, 0));
4669 } else {
4670 QualType CanonType = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType);
4671 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4672 UnderlyingType, Kind,
4673 CanonType);
4674 }
4675 Types.push_back(ut);
4676 return QualType(ut, 0);
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004677}
4678
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004679/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
4680/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
4681/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004682QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004683 bool IsDependent) const {
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004684 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004685 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004686
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004687 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004688 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004689 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004690 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004691 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4692 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004693
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00004694 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004695 Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004696 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004697 Types.push_back(AT);
4698 if (InsertPos)
4699 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
4700 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00004701}
4702
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00004703/// Return the uniqued reference to the deduced template specialization type
4704/// which has been deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced
4705/// such type, or the canonical deduced-but-dependent such type.
4706QualType ASTContext::getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(
4707 TemplateName Template, QualType DeducedType, bool IsDependent) const {
4708 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4709 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4710 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4711 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, Template, DeducedType,
4712 IsDependent);
4713 if (DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST =
4714 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4715 return QualType(DTST, 0);
4716
4717 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4718 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, DeducedType, IsDependent);
4719 Types.push_back(DTST);
4720 if (InsertPos)
4721 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(DTST, InsertPos);
4722 return QualType(DTST, 0);
4723}
4724
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004725/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
4726/// the given value type.
4727QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
4728 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
4729 // structure.
4730 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4731 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
4732
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004733 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004734 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4735 return QualType(AT, 0);
4736
4737 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4738 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4739 QualType Canonical;
4740 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4741 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
4742
4743 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4744 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004745 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004746 }
4747 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
4748 Types.push_back(New);
4749 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4750 return QualType(New, 0);
4751}
4752
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004753/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
4754QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
4755 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004756 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004757 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004758 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004759 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004760 return AutoDeductTy;
4761}
4762
4763/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
4764QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
4765 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
4766 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
4767 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
4768 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
4769}
4770
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004771/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4772/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004773QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004774 assert(Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00004775 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
4776 // away const? mutable?
4777 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004778}
4779
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004780/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4781/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4782/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00004783CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004784 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00004785}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004786
Alexander Shaposhnikov1e898d92017-07-14 17:30:14 +00004787/// Return the unique signed counterpart of the integer type
4788/// corresponding to size_t.
4789CanQualType ASTContext::getSignedSizeType() const {
4790 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSignedSizeType());
4791}
4792
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004793/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4794CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4795 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4796}
4797
4798/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4799CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4800 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4801}
4802
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00004803/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4804/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4805QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4806 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4807 return WCharTy;
4808}
4809
4810/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4811/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4812QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4813 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4814 return UnsignedIntTy;
4815}
4816
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00004817QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4818 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4819}
4820
4821QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4822 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4823}
4824
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004825/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004826/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4827QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004828 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004829}
4830
Alexander Shaposhnikov195b25c2017-09-28 23:11:31 +00004831/// \brief Return the unique unsigned counterpart of "ptrdiff_t"
4832/// integer type. The standard (C11 7.21.6.1p7) refers to this type
4833/// in the definition of %tu format specifier.
4834QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedPointerDiffType() const {
4835 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUnsignedPtrDiffType(0));
4836}
4837
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00004838/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4839/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4840QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4841 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4842}
4843
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004844//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4845// Type Operators
4846//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4847
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004848CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004849 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4850 // qualifiers.
4851 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004852 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004853 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004854 QualType Result;
4855 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4856 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4857 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4858 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4859 } else {
4860 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4861 }
4862
4863 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4864}
4865
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004866QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4867 Qualifiers &quals) {
4868 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4869
4870 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4871 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4872 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4873 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4874 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004875 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004876
4877 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004878 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004879 quals = splitType.Quals;
4880 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004881 }
4882
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004883 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4884 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4885 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4886
4887 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4888 // can just use the results in splitType.
4889 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4890 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004891 quals = splitType.Quals;
4892 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004893 }
4894
4895 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4896 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004897 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004898
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004899 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004900 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004901 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4902 }
4903
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004904 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004905 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004906 }
4907
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004908 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004909 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004910 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004911 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4912 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4913 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4914 }
4915
4916 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004917 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004918 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4919 SourceRange());
4920}
4921
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004922/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4923/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4924/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4925/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4926/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4927/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4928/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4929/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4930bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4931 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4932 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4933 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4934 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4935 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4936 return true;
4937 }
4938
4939 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4940 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4941 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4942 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4943 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4944 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4945 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4946 return true;
4947 }
4948
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004949 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004950 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4951 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4952 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4953 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4954 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4955 return true;
4956 }
4957 }
4958
4959 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4960
4961 return false;
4962}
4963
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004964DeclarationNameInfo
4965ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4966 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004967 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4968 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4969 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004970 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004971 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4972 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004973
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004974 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4975 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4976 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4977 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4978 }
4979
4980 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4981 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004982 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004983 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004984 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4985 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004986 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004987 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4988 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4989 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4990 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4991 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4992 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004993 }
4994 }
4995
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004996 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4997 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4998 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4999 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
5000 NameLoc);
5001 }
5002
5003 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
5004 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
5005 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
5006 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
5007 NameLoc);
5008 }
5009 }
5010
5011 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00005012}
5013
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005014TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005015 switch (Name.getKind()) {
5016 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
5017 case TemplateName::Template: {
5018 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00005019 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005020 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00005021 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
5022
5023 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00005024 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00005025 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00005026
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005027 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
5028 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005029
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005030 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
5031 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
5032 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
5033 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
5034 }
5035
5036 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
5037 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
5038 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
5039 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
5040 }
5041
5042 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
5043 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
5044 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
5045 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
5046 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
5047 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
5048 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
5049 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
5050 }
5051 }
5052
5053 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00005054}
5055
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00005056bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
5057 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
5058 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
5059 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
5060}
5061
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005062TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005063ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005064 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
5065 case TemplateArgument::Null:
5066 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005067
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005068 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005069 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005070
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00005071 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00005072 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00005073 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00005074 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005075
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00005076 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
5077 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
5078 /*isNullPtr*/true);
5079
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00005080 case TemplateArgument::Template:
5081 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00005082
5083 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
5084 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
5085 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00005086 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00005087
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005088 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00005089 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005090
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005091 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00005092 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005093
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005094 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00005095 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
5096 return Arg;
5097
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005098 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
5099 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005100 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005101 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005102 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
5103 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
5104 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005105
Benjamin Kramercce63472015-08-05 09:40:22 +00005106 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005107 }
5108 }
5109
5110 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005111 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005112}
5113
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005114NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005115ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005116 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005117 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005118
5119 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
5120 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
5121 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005122 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005123 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
5124 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
5125
5126 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
5127 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
5128 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005129 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00005130 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
5131
5132 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
5133 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
5134 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005135 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00005136 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
5137 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005138
5139 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
5140 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
5141 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00005142
5143 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
5144 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
5145 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
5146 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
5147 // types, e.g.,
5148 // typedef typename T::type T1;
5149 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00005150 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
5151 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00005152 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00005153
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00005154 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
5155 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
5156 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005157 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
5158 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005159 }
5160
5161 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00005162 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
5163 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005164 return NNS;
5165 }
5166
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00005167 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005168}
5169
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005170const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005171 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005172 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005173 // Handle the common positive case fast.
5174 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
5175 return AT;
5176 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005177
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005178 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005179 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005180 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005181
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005182 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005183 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
5184 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005185
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005186 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
5187 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00005188 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005189
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005190 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005191 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005192
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005193 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005194 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005195 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005196 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005197
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005198 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
5199 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005200 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005201
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005202 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
5203 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
5204 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005205 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005206 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
5207 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
5208 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005209 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00005210
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005211 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00005212 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
5213 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005214 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00005215 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00005216 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005217 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00005218 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005219
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005220 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00005221 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00005222 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005223 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005224 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00005225 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00005226}
5227
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00005228QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00005229 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
5230 return getDecayedType(T);
5231 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00005232}
5233
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00005234QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00005235 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
5236 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
5237 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
5238}
5239
David Majnemerd09a51c2015-03-03 01:50:05 +00005240QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
5241 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
5242 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
5243 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
5244 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
5245 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
5246 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
5247 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
5248 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
5249 T = getDecayedType(T);
5250 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
5251}
5252
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005253/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
5254/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
5255/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
5256/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
5257///
5258/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005259QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005260 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
5261 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
5262 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
5263 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
5264 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
5265 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005266
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005267 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005268
5269 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
Jordan Rose303e2f12016-11-10 23:28:17 +00005270 QualType Result = getQualifiedType(PtrTy,
5271 PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
5272
5273 // int x[_Nullable] -> int * _Nullable
5274 if (auto Nullability = Ty->getNullability(*this)) {
5275 Result = const_cast<ASTContext *>(this)->getAttributedType(
5276 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Nullability), Result, Result);
5277 }
5278 return Result;
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005279}
5280
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005281QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
5282 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00005283}
5284
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005285QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
5286 Qualifiers qs;
5287 while (true) {
5288 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005289 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005290 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005291
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005292 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005293 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005294 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005295
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005296 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00005297}
5298
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005299/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005300uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005301ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
5302 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
5303 do {
5304 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00005305 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
5306 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005307 } while (CA);
5308 return ElementCount;
5309}
5310
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00005311/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
5312/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005313static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005314 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00005315 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005316
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005317 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
5318 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005319 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00005320 case BuiltinType::Float16: return Float16Rank;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00005321 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00005322 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
5323 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
5324 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005325 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Float128Rank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005326 }
5327}
5328
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005329/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
5330/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00005331/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
5332/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005333QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
5334 QualType Domain) const {
5335 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
5336 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
5337 switch (EltRank) {
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00005338 case Float16Rank:
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00005339 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005340 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
5341 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
5342 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005343 case Float128Rank: return Float128ComplexTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005344 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00005345 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005346
5347 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
5348 switch (EltRank) {
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00005349 case Float16Rank: return HalfTy;
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00005350 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005351 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
5352 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
5353 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005354 case Float128Rank: return Float128Ty;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005355 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00005356 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005357}
5358
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005359/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
5360/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
5361/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005362/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005363int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005364 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
5365 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005366
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005367 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00005368 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005369 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00005370 return 1;
5371 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005372}
5373
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005374/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
5375/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
5376/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005377unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00005378 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00005379
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005380 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005381 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005382 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005383 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005384 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5385 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5386 case BuiltinType::SChar:
5387 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005388 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005389 case BuiltinType::Short:
5390 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005391 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005392 case BuiltinType::Int:
5393 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005394 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005395 case BuiltinType::Long:
5396 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005397 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005398 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
5399 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005400 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00005401 case BuiltinType::Int128:
5402 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
5403 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005404 }
5405}
5406
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005407/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
5408/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
5409///
5410/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
5411/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005412QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00005413 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
5414 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005415
5416 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
5417 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
5418 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
5419
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00005420 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005421 if (!Field)
5422 return QualType();
5423
5424 QualType FT = Field->getType();
5425
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005426 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005427 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005428 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
5429 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
5430 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
5431 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
5432 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
5433 // promotion applies to it.
5434 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
5435 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
5436 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
5437 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
5438 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
5439 //
5440 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
5441 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005442 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
5443 return IntTy;
5444
5445 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
5446 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5447
5448 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005449 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
5450 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
5451 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
5452 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005453 return QualType();
5454}
5455
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005456/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
5457/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
5458/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005459QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005460 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
5461 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00005462 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
5463 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00005464
5465 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5466 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
5467 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
5468 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
5469 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
5470 // unsigned long long int [...]
5471 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
5472 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
5473 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
5474 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
5475 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
5476 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
5477 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
5478 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
5479 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
5480 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
5481 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
5482 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
5483 (FromSize == ToSize &&
5484 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
5485 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
5486 }
5487 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
5488 }
5489 }
5490
5491 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005492 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
5493 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00005494 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
5495 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005496 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
5497 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5498}
5499
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005500/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
5501/// type and returns its ownership.
5502Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
5503 while (!T.isNull()) {
5504 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
5505 return T.getObjCLifetime();
5506 if (T->isArrayType())
5507 T = getBaseElementType(T);
5508 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
5509 T = PT->getPointeeType();
5510 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00005511 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005512 else
5513 break;
5514 }
5515
5516 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
5517}
5518
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005519static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
5520 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
5521 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
5522 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
5523 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005524 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005525}
5526
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005527/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005528/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005529/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005530int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005531 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
5532 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005533
5534 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
5535 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
5536 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5537 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
5538 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5539
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005540 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005541
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005542 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
5543 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005544
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005545 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
5546 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005547
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005548 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
5549 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
5550 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
5551 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005552
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005553 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
5554 if (LHSUnsigned) {
5555 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
5556 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
5557 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005558
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005559 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5560 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005561 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005562 return -1;
5563 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005564
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005565 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
5566 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
5567 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005568
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005569 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5570 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005571 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005572 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005573}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005574
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005575TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005576 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005577 assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl &&
5578 "tag and typedef should be initialized together");
5579 CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag");
5580 CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00005581
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005582 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005583 const char *FieldNames[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005584
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005585 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005586 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005587 FieldNames[0] = "isa";
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005588 // int flags;
5589 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005590 FieldNames[1] = "flags";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005591 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005592 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005593 FieldNames[2] = "str";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005594 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005595 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005596 FieldNames[3] = "length";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005597
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005598 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005599 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005600 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00005601 SourceLocation(),
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005602 SourceLocation(),
5603 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005604 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5605 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00005606 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00005607 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005608 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005609 CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005610 }
5611
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005612 CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5613 // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot
5614 // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface.
5615 auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl);
5616 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
5617 buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString");
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005618 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005619
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005620 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
5621}
5622
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005623RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const {
5624 if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl)
5625 getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef.
5626 return CFConstantStringTagDecl;
5627}
5628
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005629// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
5630QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005631 return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl());
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00005632}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00005633
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005634QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
5635 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005636 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005637 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5638 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5639 }
5640 return ObjCSuperType;
5641}
5642
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005643void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005644 const TypedefType *TD = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
5645 assert(TD && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5646 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl());
5647 auto TagType =
5648 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<RecordType>();
5649 assert(TagType && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5650 CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005651}
5652
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005653QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005654 if (BlockDescriptorType)
5655 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5656
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005657 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005658 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005659 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
5660 RD->startDefinition();
5661
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005662 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5663 UnsignedLongTy,
5664 UnsignedLongTy,
5665 };
5666
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005667 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005668 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005669 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005670 };
5671
5672 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005673 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5674 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005675 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5676 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005677 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005678 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005679 }
5680
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005681 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005682
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005683 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005684
5685 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5686}
5687
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005688QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005689 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
5690 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5691
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005692 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005693 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005694 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
5695 RD->startDefinition();
5696
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005697 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5698 UnsignedLongTy,
5699 UnsignedLongTy,
5700 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
5701 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
5702 };
5703
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005704 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005705 "reserved",
5706 "Size",
5707 "CopyFuncPtr",
5708 "DestroyFuncPtr"
5709 };
5710
5711 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005712 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5713 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005714 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5715 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005716 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005717 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005718 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005719 }
5720
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005721 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005722
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005723 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005724 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5725}
5726
Sven van Haastregt3bb7eaf2017-12-06 10:11:28 +00005727TargetInfo::OpenCLTypeKind ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeKind(const Type *T) const {
5728 auto BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(T);
5729
5730 if (!BT) {
5731 if (isa<PipeType>(T))
5732 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Pipe;
5733
5734 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Default;
5735 }
5736
5737 switch (BT->getKind()) {
5738#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
5739 case BuiltinType::Id: \
5740 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Image;
5741#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
5742
5743 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
5744 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_ClkEvent;
5745
5746 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
5747 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Event;
5748
5749 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
5750 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Queue;
5751
5752 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
5753 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_ReserveID;
5754
5755 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
5756 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Sampler;
5757
5758 default:
5759 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Default;
5760 }
5761}
5762
5763LangAS ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(const Type *T) const {
5764 return Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T));
5765}
5766
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005767/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
5768/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
5769/// in buildByrefHelpers.
5770bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
5771 const VarDecl *D) {
5772 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
5773 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
5774 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
5775
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005776 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00005777 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005778
5779 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
5780
5781 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
5782
5783 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
5784 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005785 switch (lifetime) {
5786 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
5787
5788 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
5789 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
5790 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
5791 return false;
5792
5793 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
5794 // byref routines.
5795 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
5796 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
5797 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
5798 return true;
5799 }
5800 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
5801 }
5802 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
5803 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005804}
5805
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005806bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
5807 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
5808 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005809 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
5810 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
5811 return false;
5812
5813 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00005814 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005815 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
5816 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005817 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
5818 // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
5819 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
5820 // The MRR rule.
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005821 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005822 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005823 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005824 }
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005825 return true;
5826}
5827
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005828TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
5829 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005830 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
5831 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005832 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
5833}
5834
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005835// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
5836// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00005837static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005838 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00005839 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
5840 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005841
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005842 return false;
5843}
5844
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005845/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005846/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005847CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005848 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
5849 return CharUnits::Zero();
5850
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005851 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005852
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005853 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00005854 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005855 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005856 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
5857 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005858 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005859 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005860}
5861
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005862bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00005863 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
5864 VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
David Majnemerfac52432015-10-19 23:22:49 +00005865 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5866 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005867}
5868
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005869ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind
5870ASTContext::getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl *VD) const {
5871 if (!VD->isInline())
5872 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None;
5873
5874 // In almost all cases, it's a weak definition.
5875 auto *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
Richard Smith8910fe62017-10-23 03:58:34 +00005876 if (First->isInlineSpecified() || !First->isStaticDataMember())
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005877 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak;
5878
5879 // If there's a file-context declaration in this translation unit, it's a
5880 // non-discardable definition.
5881 for (auto *D : VD->redecls())
Richard Smith8910fe62017-10-23 03:58:34 +00005882 if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFileContext() &&
5883 !D->isInlineSpecified() && (D->isConstexpr() || First->isConstexpr()))
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005884 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong;
5885
5886 // If we've not seen one yet, we don't know.
5887 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown;
5888}
5889
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005890static inline
5891std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5892 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005893}
5894
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005895/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005896/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005897std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5898 std::string S;
5899
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005900 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5901 QualType BlockTy =
5902 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5903 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005904 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005905 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5906 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5907 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005908 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005909 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005910 // Compute size of all parameters.
5911 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5912 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005913 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5914 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005915 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005916 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005917 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00005918 if (sz.isZero())
5919 continue;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00005920 assert(sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005921 ParmOffset += sz;
5922 }
5923 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005924 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005925 // Block pointer and offset.
5926 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005927
5928 // Argument types.
5929 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005930 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005931 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5932 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5933 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5934 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5935 // elements.
5936 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5937 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5938 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5939 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005940 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005941 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5942 S, true /*Extended*/);
5943 else
5944 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005945 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005946 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005947 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005948
5949 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005950}
5951
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005952std::string
5953ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl) const {
5954 std::string S;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005955 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005956 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005957 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5958 // Compute size of all parameters.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005959 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005960 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005961 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005962 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005963 continue;
5964
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005965 assert(sz.isPositive() &&
5966 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005967 ParmOffset += sz;
5968 }
5969 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5970 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5971
5972 // Argument types.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005973 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005974 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5975 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5976 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5977 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5978 // elements.
5979 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5980 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5981 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5982 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5983 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5984 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5985 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5986 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005987
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005988 return S;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005989}
5990
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005991/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5992/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5993/// block object types.
5994void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5995 QualType T, std::string& S,
5996 bool Extended) const {
5997 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5998 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5999 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006000 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006001 true /*OutermostType*/,
6002 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
6003 false /*StructField*/,
6004 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
6005 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
6006}
6007
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006008/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006009/// declaration.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006010std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
6011 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006012 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006013 // Encode return type.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006014 std::string S;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006015 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
6016 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006017 // Compute size of all parameters.
6018 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
6019 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006020 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006021 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
6022 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006023 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00006024 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00006025 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00006026 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00006027 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00006028 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00006029 continue;
6030
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006031 assert(sz.isPositive() &&
6032 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006033 ParmOffset += sz;
6034 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006035 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006036 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006037 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006038
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006039 // Argument types.
6040 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00006041 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00006042 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00006043 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006044 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00006045 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00006046 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
6047 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
6048 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00006049 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00006050 PType = PVDecl->getType();
6051 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
6052 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006053 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
6054 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006055 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00006056 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006057 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00006058
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006059 return S;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006060}
6061
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006062ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
6063ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
6064 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
6065 const Decl *Container) const {
6066 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006067 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006068 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
6069 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00006070 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
6071 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
6072 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006073 } else {
6074 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
6075 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
6076 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
6077 return PID;
6078 }
6079 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006080}
6081
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006082/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00006083/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006084/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
6085/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006086/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
6087/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
6088/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
6089/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
6090/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00006091/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
6092/// @code
6093/// enum PropertyAttributes {
6094/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
6095/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
6096/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
6097/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
6098/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
6099/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
6100/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00006101/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00006102/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
6103/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
6104/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
6105/// };
6106/// @endcode
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006107std::string
6108ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
6109 const Decl *Container) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006110 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
6111 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006112 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006113
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006114 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
6115 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
6116 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
6117 Dynamic = true;
6118 else
6119 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006120 }
6121
6122 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006123 std::string S = "T";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006124
6125 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006126 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
6127 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00006128 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006129
6130 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
6131 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00006132 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
6133 S += ",C";
6134 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
6135 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00006136 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
6137 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006138 } else {
6139 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
6140 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
6141 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006142 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00006143 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006144 }
6145 }
6146
6147 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
6148 // are "dynamic by default".
6149 if (Dynamic)
6150 S += ",D";
6151
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006152 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
6153 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006154
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006155 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
6156 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00006157 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006158 }
6159
6160 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
6161 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00006162 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006163 }
6164
6165 if (SynthesizePID) {
6166 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
6167 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00006168 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006169 }
6170
6171 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006172 return S;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006173}
6174
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006175/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006176/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
6177/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006178/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006179void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00006180 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006181 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006182 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006183 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006184 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006185 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006186 PointeeTy = IntTy;
6187 }
6188 }
6189}
6190
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006191void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006192 const FieldDecl *Field,
6193 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006194 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
6195 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
6196 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
6197 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006198 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006199 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
6200 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006201}
6202
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00006203void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
6204 std::string& S) const {
6205 // Encode result type.
6206 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
6207 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
6208 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
6209 true /* outermost type */,
6210 true /* encoding property */);
6211}
6212
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006213static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
6214 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
6215 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006216 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
6217 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
6218 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
6219 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006220 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006221 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006222 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006223 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
6224 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006225 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006226 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
6227 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
6228 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
6229 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
6230 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00006231 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
6232 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006233 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
6234 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006235 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006236 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
6237 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
6238 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
6239 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00006240 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006241 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
6242
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00006243 case BuiltinType::Float16:
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00006244 case BuiltinType::Float128:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006245 case BuiltinType::Half:
6246 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
6247 return ' ';
6248
6249 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
6250 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
6251 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
6252 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
6253
6254 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00006255#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
6256 case BuiltinType::Id:
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00006257#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00006258 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00006259 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
6260 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00006261 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00006262 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006263 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
6264#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
6265#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
6266 case BuiltinType::KIND:
6267#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
6268 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006269 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00006270 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006271}
6272
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00006273static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
6274 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
6275
6276 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
6277 if (!Enum->isFixed())
6278 return 'i';
6279
6280 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006281 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
6282 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00006283}
6284
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006285static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006286 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006287 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00006288 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006289 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
6290 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
6291 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
6292 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
6293 //
6294 // struct
6295 // {
6296 // int integer;
6297 // int flags:2;
6298 // };
6299 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
6300 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
6301 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
6302 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
6303 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00006304 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
Akira Hatanaka4b1c4842017-06-27 04:34:04 +00006305 uint64_t Offset;
6306
6307 if (const auto *IVD = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(FD)) {
6308 Offset = Ctx->lookupFieldBitOffset(IVD->getContainingInterface(), nullptr,
6309 IVD);
6310 } else {
6311 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
6312 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
6313 Offset = RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex());
6314 }
6315
6316 S += llvm::utostr(Offset);
6317
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00006318 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
6319 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006320 else {
6321 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
6322 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
6323 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006324 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006325 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00006326}
6327
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00006328// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006329void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
6330 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
6331 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00006332 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006333 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006334 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006335 bool StructField,
6336 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006337 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006338 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
6339 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006340 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
6341 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
6342 case Type::Builtin:
6343 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006344 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006345 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006346 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
6347 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
6348 else
6349 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006350 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006351
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006352 case Type::Complex: {
6353 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00006354 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006355 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006356 return;
6357 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006358
6359 case Type::Atomic: {
6360 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
6361 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006362 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006363 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00006364 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006365
6366 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
6367 case Type::Pointer:
6368 case Type::LValueReference:
6369 case Type::RValueReference: {
6370 QualType PointeeTy;
6371 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
6372 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
6373 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
6374 S += ':';
6375 return;
6376 }
6377 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
6378 } else {
6379 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
6380 }
6381
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006382 bool isReadOnly = false;
6383 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
6384 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
6385 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006386 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00006387 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006388 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
6389 isReadOnly = true;
6390 S += 'r';
6391 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00006392 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006393 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006394 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
6395 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006396 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
6397 isReadOnly = true;
6398 S += 'r';
6399 }
6400 }
6401 if (isReadOnly) {
6402 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
6403 // combinations need to be rearranged.
6404 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006405 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00006406 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006407 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006408
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006409 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
6410 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
6411 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00006412 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006413 S += '*';
6414 return;
6415 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006416 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00006417 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
6418 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
6419 S += '#';
6420 return;
6421 }
6422 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
6423 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
6424 S += '@';
6425 return;
6426 }
6427 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006428 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006429 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006430 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
6431
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006432 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006433 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
6434 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006435 return;
6436 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006437
6438 case Type::ConstantArray:
6439 case Type::IncompleteArray:
6440 case Type::VariableArray: {
6441 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
6442
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006443 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006444 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
6445 S += '^';
6446
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006447 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006448 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
6449 } else {
6450 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006451
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00006452 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
6453 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
6454 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006455 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006456 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
6457 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006458 S += '0';
6459 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006460
6461 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006462 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
6463 false, false, false, false, false, false,
6464 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006465 S += ']';
6466 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006467 return;
6468 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006469
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006470 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
6471 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00006472 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006473 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006474
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006475 case Type::Record: {
6476 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006477 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006478 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
6479 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
6480 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006481 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
6482 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
6483 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00006484 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
Serge Pavlov03e672c2017-11-28 16:14:14 +00006485 printTemplateArgumentList(OS, TemplateArgs.asArray(),
6486 getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006487 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006488 } else {
6489 S += '?';
6490 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00006491 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006492 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006493 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006494 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006495 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006496 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006497 if (FD) {
6498 S += '"';
6499 S += Field->getNameAsString();
6500 S += '"';
6501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006502
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006503 // Special case bit-fields.
6504 if (Field->isBitField()) {
6505 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006506 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006507 } else {
6508 QualType qt = Field->getType();
6509 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6510 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
6511 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
6512 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006513 /*StructField*/true,
6514 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006515 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006516 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006517 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00006518 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006519 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006520 return;
6521 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006522
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006523 case Type::BlockPointer: {
6524 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00006525 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006526 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006527 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006528
6529 S += '<';
6530 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006531 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6532 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
6533 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006534 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
6535 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006536 // Block self
6537 S += "@?";
6538 // Block parameters
6539 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00006540 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
6541 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6542 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
6543 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006544 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
6545 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006546 }
6547 S += '>';
6548 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006549 return;
6550 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006551
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00006552 case Type::ObjCObject: {
6553 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
6554 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
6555 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
6556 S += "{objc_object=}";
6557 return;
6558 }
6559 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
6560 S += "{objc_class=}";
6561 return;
6562 }
Galina Kistanovaf87496d2017-06-03 06:31:42 +00006563 // TODO: Double check to make sure this intentially falls through.
6564 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00006565 }
6566
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006567 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
6568 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006569 // @encode(class_name)
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006570 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006571 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006572 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Akira Hatanakafd0fb202016-08-17 19:42:22 +00006573 if (ExpandStructures) {
6574 S += '=';
6575 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6576 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6577 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6578 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
6579 if (Field->isBitField())
6580 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
6581 else
6582 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
6583 false, false, false, false, false,
6584 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
6585 NotEncodedT);
6586 }
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006587 }
6588 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006589 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006590 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006591
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006592 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
6593 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006594 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
6595 S += '@';
6596 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006597 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006598
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00006599 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
6600 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
6601 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
6602 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006603 S += '#';
6604 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006605 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006606
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006607 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006608 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006609 ExpandPointedToStructures,
6610 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006611 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006612 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
6613 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006614 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006615 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006616 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006617 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006618 S += '>';
6619 }
6620 S += '"';
6621 }
6622 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006623 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006624
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006625 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
6626 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006627 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
6628 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006629 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006630 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006631 // {...};
6632 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006633 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00006634 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006635 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
6636 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6637 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6638 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6639 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
6640 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006641 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006642 S += '}';
6643 return;
6644 }
6645 }
6646 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006647 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
6648 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006649 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006650 false, false, false, false, false,
6651 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006652 return;
6653 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006654
6655 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006656 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
6657 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006658 S += '"';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006659 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006660 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006661 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006662 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006663 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006664 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006665 S += '"';
6666 }
6667 return;
6668 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006669
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00006670 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006671 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
6672 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006673 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
6674 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006675 case Type::Vector:
6676 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006677 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006678 if (NotEncodedT)
6679 *NotEncodedT = T;
6680 return;
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006681
6682 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
6683 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006684 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00006685 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006686 return;
6687
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00006688 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006689#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6690#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6691#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6692 case Type::KIND:
6693#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6694 case Type::KIND:
6695#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6696 case Type::KIND:
6697#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
6698 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00006699 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006700 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006701}
6702
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006703void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
6704 std::string &S,
6705 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006706 bool includeVBases,
6707 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006708 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
6709 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis785705b2016-01-16 00:20:02 +00006710 if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006711 return;
6712
6713 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
6714 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
6715 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
6716
6717 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00006718 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
6719 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
6720 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006721 if (base->isEmpty())
6722 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006723 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006724 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
6725 std::make_pair(offs, base));
6726 }
6727 }
6728 }
6729
6730 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006731 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006732 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
6733 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006734 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
6735 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006736 }
6737
6738 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00006739 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
6740 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006741 if (base->isEmpty())
6742 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006743 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00006744 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
6745 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00006746 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
6747 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006748 }
6749 }
6750
6751 CharUnits size;
6752 if (CXXRec) {
6753 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
6754 } else {
6755 size = layout.getSize();
6756 }
6757
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006758#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006759 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006760#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006761 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
6762 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
6763
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00006764 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
6765 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006766 if (FD) {
6767 S += "\"_vptr$";
6768 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
6769 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
6770 S += recname;
6771 S += '"';
6772 }
6773 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006774#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006775 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006776#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006777 }
6778
6779 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
6780 // Mark the end of the structure.
6781 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
6782 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006783 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006784 }
6785
6786 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006787#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006788 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006789 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
6790 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
6791 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
6792 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
6793 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
6794 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
6795 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
6796 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
6797 // longer then though.
6798 CurOffs += padding;
6799 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006800#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006801
6802 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006803 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006804 break; // reached end of structure.
6805
6806 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
6807 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
6808 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
6809 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
6810 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006811 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
6812 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006813 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006814#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006815 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006816#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006817 } else {
6818 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
6819 if (FD) {
6820 S += '"';
6821 S += field->getNameAsString();
6822 S += '"';
6823 }
6824
6825 if (field->isBitField()) {
6826 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006827#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006828 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006829#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006830 } else {
6831 QualType qt = field->getType();
6832 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6833 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
6834 /*OutermostType*/false,
6835 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006836 /*StructField*/true,
6837 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006838#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006839 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006840#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006841 }
6842 }
6843 }
6844}
6845
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006846void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00006847 std::string& S) const {
6848 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
6849 S += 'n';
6850 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
6851 S += 'N';
6852 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
6853 S += 'o';
6854 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
6855 S += 'O';
6856 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
6857 S += 'R';
6858 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
6859 S += 'V';
6860}
6861
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006862TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
6863 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006864 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, {});
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006865 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006866 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006867 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006868 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00006869}
6870
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006871TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
6872 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006873 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
6874 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006875 }
6876 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00006877}
6878
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006879TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
6880 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006881 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, {});
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006882 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006883 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006884 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006885 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00006886}
6887
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006888ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
6889 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
6890 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
6891 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6892 SourceLocation(),
6893 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Douglas Gregor85f3f952015-07-07 03:57:15 +00006894 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006895 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006896 SourceLocation(), true);
6897 }
6898
6899 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
6900}
6901
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006902//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6903// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
6904//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6905
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006906static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6907 StringRef Name) {
6908 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006909 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006910 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
6911}
6912
6913static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6914 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
6915}
6916
6917static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6918 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006919}
6920
6921static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6922 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006923 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6924 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006925}
6926
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006927static TypedefDecl *
6928CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006929 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006930 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006931 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6932 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6933 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6934 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6935 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006936 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006937 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006938 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006939 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006940 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006941 }
6942
6943 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6944
6945 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6946 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6947 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6948
6949 // void *__stack;
6950 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6951 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6952
6953 // void *__gr_top;
6954 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6955 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6956
6957 // void *__vr_top;
6958 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6959 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6960
6961 // int __gr_offs;
6962 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6963 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6964
6965 // int __vr_offs;
6966 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6967 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6968
6969 // Create fields
6970 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6971 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6972 VaListTagDecl,
6973 SourceLocation(),
6974 SourceLocation(),
6975 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006976 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6977 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006978 /*Mutable=*/false,
6979 ICIS_NoInit);
6980 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6981 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6982 }
6983 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006984 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006985 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006986
6987 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006988 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006989}
6990
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006991static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6992 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6993 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6994
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006995 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006996 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6997
6998 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6999 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
7000 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
7001
7002 // unsigned char gpr;
7003 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
7004 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
7005
7006 // unsigned char fpr;
7007 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
7008 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
7009
7010 // unsigned short reserved;
7011 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
7012 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
7013
7014 // void* overflow_arg_area;
7015 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7016 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
7017
7018 // void* reg_save_area;
7019 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7020 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
7021
7022 // Create fields
7023 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
7024 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
7025 SourceLocation(),
7026 SourceLocation(),
7027 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007028 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7029 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007030 /*Mutable=*/false,
7031 ICIS_NoInit);
7032 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7033 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7034 }
7035 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007036 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007037 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
7038
7039 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007040 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
7041 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
7042
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007043 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
7044 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
7045
7046 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
7047 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
7048 QualType VaListTagArrayType
7049 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
7050 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007051 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007052}
7053
7054static TypedefDecl *
7055CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007056 // struct __va_list_tag {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007057 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00007058 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007059 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
7060
7061 const size_t NumFields = 4;
7062 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
7063 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
7064
7065 // unsigned gp_offset;
7066 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
7067 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
7068
7069 // unsigned fp_offset;
7070 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
7071 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
7072
7073 // void* overflow_arg_area;
7074 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7075 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
7076
7077 // void* reg_save_area;
7078 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7079 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
7080
7081 // Create fields
7082 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
7083 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7084 VaListTagDecl,
7085 SourceLocation(),
7086 SourceLocation(),
7087 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007088 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7089 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007090 /*Mutable=*/false,
7091 ICIS_NoInit);
7092 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7093 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7094 }
7095 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007096 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007097 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
7098
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007099 // };
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007100
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007101 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007102 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007103 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
7104 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007105 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007106}
7107
7108static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
7109 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
7110 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
Yaron Kerene0bcdd42016-10-08 06:45:10 +00007111 QualType IntArrayType =
7112 Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007113 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007114}
7115
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007116static TypedefDecl *
7117CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007118 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00007119 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007120 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7121 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
7122 NamespaceDecl *NS;
7123 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7124 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
7125 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
7126 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007127 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007128 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007129 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007130 }
7131
7132 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
7133
7134 // void * __ap;
7135 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7136 VaListDecl,
7137 SourceLocation(),
7138 SourceLocation(),
7139 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
7140 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007141 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7142 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007143 /*Mutable=*/false,
7144 ICIS_NoInit);
7145 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7146 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
7147
7148 // };
7149 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
Oleg Ranevskyyb88d2472016-03-30 21:30:30 +00007150 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListDecl;
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007151
7152 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007153 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
7154 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007155}
7156
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007157static TypedefDecl *
7158CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007159 // struct __va_list_tag {
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007160 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00007161 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007162 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
7163
7164 const size_t NumFields = 4;
7165 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
7166 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
7167
7168 // long __gpr;
7169 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
7170 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
7171
7172 // long __fpr;
7173 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
7174 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
7175
7176 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
7177 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7178 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
7179
7180 // void *__reg_save_area;
7181 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7182 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
7183
7184 // Create fields
7185 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
7186 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7187 VaListTagDecl,
7188 SourceLocation(),
7189 SourceLocation(),
7190 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007191 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7192 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007193 /*Mutable=*/false,
7194 ICIS_NoInit);
7195 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7196 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7197 }
7198 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007199 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007200 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007201
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007202 // };
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007203
7204 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
7205 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007206 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
7207 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007208
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007209 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007210}
7211
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007212static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
7213 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
7214 switch (Kind) {
7215 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
7216 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
7217 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
7218 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00007219 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
7220 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007221 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
7222 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
7223 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
7224 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
7225 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
7226 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007227 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
7228 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007229 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
7230 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007231 }
7232
7233 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
7234}
7235
7236TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007237 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007238 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007239 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
7240 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007241
7242 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
7243}
7244
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007245Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
7246 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00007247 // declaration.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007248 if (!VaListTagDecl)
7249 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00007250
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007251 return VaListTagDecl;
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00007252}
7253
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00007254TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
7255 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
7256 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
7257
7258 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
7259}
7260
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00007261void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007262 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00007263 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007264
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00007265 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00007266}
7267
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00007268/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
7269/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007270TemplateName
7271ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
7272 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00007273 unsigned size = End - Begin;
7274 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
7275
7276 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
7277 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
7278 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
7279
7280 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00007281 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00007282 NamedDecl *D = *I;
7283 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
7284 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
7285 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
7286 *Storage++ = D;
7287 }
7288
7289 return TemplateName(OT);
7290}
7291
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007292/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
7293/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007294TemplateName
7295ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
7296 bool TemplateKeyword,
7297 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00007298 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
7299
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007300 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007301 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7302 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
7303
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007304 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007305 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
7306 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7307 if (!QTN) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007308 QTN = new (*this, alignof(QualifiedTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007309 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007310 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7311 }
7312
7313 return TemplateName(QTN);
7314}
7315
7316/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
7317/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007318TemplateName
7319ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
7320 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007321 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00007322 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007323
7324 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7325 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
7326
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007327 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007328 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
7329 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7330
7331 if (QTN)
7332 return TemplateName(QTN);
7333
7334 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
7335 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007336 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007337 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007338 } else {
7339 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007340 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007341 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007342 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
7343 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7344 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
7345 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007346 }
7347
7348 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7349 return TemplateName(QTN);
7350}
7351
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007352/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
7353/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
7354TemplateName
7355ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007356 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007357 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
7358 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
7359
7360 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7361 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007362
7363 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007364 DependentTemplateName *QTN
7365 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007366
7367 if (QTN)
7368 return TemplateName(QTN);
7369
7370 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
7371 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007372 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007373 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007374 } else {
7375 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007376 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007377 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007378
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007379 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
7380 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7381 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
7382 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007383 }
7384
7385 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7386 return TemplateName(QTN);
7387}
7388
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007389TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007390ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
7391 TemplateName replacement) const {
7392 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7393 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007394
7395 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007396 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
7397 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
7398
7399 if (!subst) {
7400 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
7401 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
7402 }
7403
7404 return TemplateName(subst);
7405}
7406
7407TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007408ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
7409 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
7410 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
7411 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7412 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007413
7414 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007415 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
7416 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7417
7418 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007419 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007420 ArgPack.pack_size(),
7421 ArgPack.pack_begin());
7422 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
7423 }
7424
7425 return TemplateName(Subst);
7426}
7427
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007428/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00007429/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
7430/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007431CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007432 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007433 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00007434 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
7435 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007436 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
7437 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
7438 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
7439 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
7440 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
7441 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
7442 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
7443 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
7444 }
7445
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007446 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007447}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00007448
7449//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7450// Type Predicates.
7451//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7452
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007453/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
7454/// garbage collection attribute.
7455///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007456Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007457 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007458 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
7459
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007460 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007461 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
7462
7463 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
7464 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
7465 // as __strong.
7466 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
7467 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
7468 return Qualifiers::Strong;
7469 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
7470 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
7471 } else {
7472 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
7473 // pointer.
7474#ifndef NDEBUG
7475 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
7476 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
7477 CT = AT->getElementType();
7478 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
7479#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007480 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00007481 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007482}
7483
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007484//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7485// Type Compatibility Testing
7486//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00007487
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007488/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007489/// compatible.
7490static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
7491 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00007492 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007493 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007494 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007495}
7496
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007497bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
7498 QualType SecondVec) {
7499 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
7500 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
7501
7502 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
7503 return true;
7504
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007505 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
7506 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007507 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
7508 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007509 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007510 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007511 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7512 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
7513 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7514 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007515 return true;
7516
7517 return false;
7518}
7519
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007520//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7521// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
7522//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7523
7524/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
7525/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007526bool
7527ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
7528 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00007529 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007530 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00007531 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
7532 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007533 return true;
7534 return false;
7535}
7536
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00007537/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
7538/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007539bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
7540 QualType rhs) {
7541 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7542 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00007543 assert((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007544
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007545 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007546 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007547 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007548 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
7549 match = true;
7550 break;
7551 }
7552 }
7553 if (!match)
7554 return false;
7555 }
7556 return true;
7557}
7558
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007559/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
7560/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
7561bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7562 bool compare) {
7563 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007564 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007565 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
7566 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007567 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007568 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
7569 return true;
7570
7571 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007572 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007573
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007574 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007575
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007576 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007577 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007578 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7579 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007580 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007581 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7582 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7583 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007584 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007585 return false;
7586 }
7587 }
7588 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
7589 return true;
7590 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007591 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007592 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007593 bool match = false;
7594
7595 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7596 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7597 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007598 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007599 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7600 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7601 match = true;
7602 break;
7603 }
7604 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007605 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007606 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7607 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007608 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007609 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7610 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7611 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007612 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007613 match = true;
7614 break;
7615 }
7616 }
7617 }
7618 if (!match)
7619 return false;
7620 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007621
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007622 return true;
7623 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007624
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007625 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
7626 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
7627
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007628 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007629 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007630 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007631 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007632 bool match = false;
7633
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007634 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007635 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7636 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007637 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
7638 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007639 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007640 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7641 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7642 match = true;
7643 break;
7644 }
7645 }
7646 if (!match)
7647 return false;
7648 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007649
7650 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
7651 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
7652 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
7653 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
7654 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
7655 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
7656 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
7657 // assume that it is mismatch.
7658 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
7659 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007660 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007661 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007662 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007663 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7664 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7665 match = true;
7666 break;
7667 }
7668 }
7669 if (!match)
7670 return false;
7671 }
7672 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007673 return true;
7674 }
7675 return false;
7676}
7677
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007678/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007679/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
7680/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007681bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7682 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007683 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7684 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7685
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00007686 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007687 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
7688 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007689 return true;
7690
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007691 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7692 // __kindof types.
7693 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7694 if (succeeded)
7695 return true;
7696
7697 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
7698 return false;
7699
7700 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7701 // we can assign the other way.
7702 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7703 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
7704 };
7705
7706 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
7707 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7708 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7709 false));
7710 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007711
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007712 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
7713 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7714 QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
7715 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007716
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007717 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007718 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
7719 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
7720 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007721
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007722 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007723}
7724
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007725/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00007726/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007727/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
7728/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
7729/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
7730bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7731 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007732 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
7733 bool BlockReturnType) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007734
7735 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7736 // __kindof types.
7737 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7738 if (succeeded)
7739 return true;
7740
7741 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
7742 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
7743 return false;
7744
7745 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7746 // we can assign the other way.
7747 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7748 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7749 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7750 BlockReturnType);
7751 };
7752
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007753 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007754 return true;
7755
7756 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007757 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
7758 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007759 }
7760
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007761 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007762 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7763 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7764 false));
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007765
7766 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7767 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7768 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
7769 if (LHS != RHS) {
7770 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007771 return finish(BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007772 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007773 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007774 }
7775 else
7776 return true;
7777 }
7778 return false;
7779}
7780
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007781/// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
7782/// llvm::array_pod_sort.
7783static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
7784 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
7785 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007786}
7787
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007788/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007789/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
7790/// the given common base.
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007791/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
7792/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
7793static
7794void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007795 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007796 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7797 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007798 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007799
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007800 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7801 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7802 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
7803 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007804
7805 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
7806 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
7807
7808 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7809 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
7810 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007811 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007812
7813 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
7814 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
7815
7816 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
7817 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
7818
7819 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7820 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
7821 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007822 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007823
7824 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
7825 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
7826
7827 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
7828 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
7829 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
7830 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
7831 }
7832
7833 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
7834 // the protocols within the intersection.
7835 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
7836 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
7837
7838 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
7839 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
7840 IntersectionSet.erase(
7841 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
7842 IntersectionSet.end(),
7843 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
7844 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
7845 }),
7846 IntersectionSet.end());
7847 }
7848
7849 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
7850 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
7851 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007852}
7853
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007854/// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
7855static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
7856 QualType rhs) {
7857 // Common case: two object pointers.
7858 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7859 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7860 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
7861 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
7862
7863 // Two block pointers.
7864 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7865 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7866 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
7867 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
7868
7869 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
7870 // acceptable.
7871 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
7872 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
7873 return true;
7874
7875 return false;
7876}
7877
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007878// Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007879static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
7880 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
7881 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007882 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
7883 bool stripKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007884 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
7885 return false;
7886
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007887 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007888 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007889 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7890 continue;
7891
7892 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
7893 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007894 if (!stripKindOf ||
7895 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
7896 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
7897 return false;
7898 }
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007899 break;
7900
7901 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
7902 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7903 return false;
7904 break;
7905
7906 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
7907 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7908 return false;
7909 break;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007910 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007911 }
7912
7913 return true;
7914}
7915
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007916QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007917 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7918 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007919 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7920 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7921 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7922 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007923
7924 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007925 return QualType();
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007926
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007927 // When either LHS or RHS is a kindof type, we should return a kindof type.
7928 // For example, for common base of kindof(ASub1) and kindof(ASub2), we return
7929 // kindof(A).
7930 bool anyKindOf = LHS->isKindOfType() || RHS->isKindOfType();
7931
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007932 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7933 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7934 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7935 LHSAncestors;
7936 while (true) {
7937 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7938 // path from the LHS to the root.
7939 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007940
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007941 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7942 // Get the type arguments.
7943 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7944 bool anyChanges = false;
7945 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7946 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007947 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7948 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007949 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007950 return QualType();
7951 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7952 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7953 // arguments.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00007954 LHSTypeArgs = {};
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007955 anyChanges = true;
7956 }
7957
7958 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007959 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007960 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7961 Protocols);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007962 if (!Protocols.empty())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007963 anyChanges = true;
7964
7965 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007966 // If we need to return a kindof type but LHS is not a kindof type, we
7967 // build a new result type.
7968 if (anyChanges || LHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007969 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007970 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007971 anyKindOf || LHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007972 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7973 }
7974
7975 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007976 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007977
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007978 // Find the superclass.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007979 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7980 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7981 break;
7982
7983 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7984 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007985
7986 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7987 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7988 while (true) {
7989 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7990 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7991 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7992
7993 // Get the type arguments.
7994 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7995 bool anyChanges = false;
7996 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7997 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007998 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7999 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00008000 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008001 return QualType();
8002 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
8003 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
8004 // arguments.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008005 RHSTypeArgs = {};
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008006 anyChanges = true;
8007 }
8008
8009 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
8010 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
8011 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
8012 Protocols);
8013 if (!Protocols.empty())
8014 anyChanges = true;
8015
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00008016 // If we need to return a kindof type but RHS is not a kindof type, we
8017 // build a new result type.
8018 if (anyChanges || RHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008019 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00008020 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00008021 anyKindOf || RHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008022 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
8023 }
8024
8025 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
8026 }
8027
8028 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
8029 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
8030 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
8031 break;
8032
8033 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8034 }
8035
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00008036 return QualType();
8037}
8038
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008039bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
8040 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
8041 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
8042 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
8043
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008044 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
8045 // the LHS.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008046 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
8047 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
8048 if (!IsSuperClass)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008049 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008050
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008051 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
8052 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
8053 // LHS).
8054 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00008055 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
8056 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
8057 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
8058 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
8059 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
8060 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
8061 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
8062 // qualifiers.
8063 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008064 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00008065 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
8066 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00008067 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00008068
8069 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
8070 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
8071 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
8072 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
8073 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
8074 break;
8075 }
8076 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
8077 return false;
8078 }
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008079 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008080
8081 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
8082 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
8083 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
8084 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
8085 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
8086 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
8087 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8088
8089 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008090 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00008091 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
8092 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00008093 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008094 return false;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008095 }
8096 }
8097
8098 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008099}
8100
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00008101bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8102 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008103 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8104 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008105
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008106 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00008107 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008108
8109 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
8110 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00008111}
8112
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00008113bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
8114 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
8115 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8116 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
8117}
8118
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008119/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008120/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008121/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008122/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008123bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
8124 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008125 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008126 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00008127
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008128 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008129}
8130
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00008131bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00008132 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00008133}
8134
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008135bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8136 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
8137}
8138
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00008139/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
8140/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
8141/// QualType()
8142QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
8143 bool OfBlockPointer,
8144 bool Unqualified) {
8145 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
8146 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
8147 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00008148 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
8149 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00008150 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
8151 if (!MT.isNull())
8152 return MT;
8153 }
8154 }
8155 }
8156
8157 return QualType();
8158}
8159
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008160/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
8161/// parameter types
8162QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
8163 bool OfBlockPointer,
8164 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00008165 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
8166 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
8167 // type is compatible with a union member
8168 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
8169 Unqualified);
8170 if (!lmerge.isNull())
8171 return lmerge;
8172
8173 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
8174 Unqualified);
8175 if (!rmerge.isNull())
8176 return rmerge;
8177
8178 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
8179}
8180
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008181QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008182 bool OfBlockPointer,
8183 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008184 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
8185 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008186 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
8187 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008188 bool allLTypes = true;
8189 bool allRTypes = true;
8190
8191 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008192 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00008193 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008194 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
8195 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00008196 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
8197 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
8198 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008199 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00008200 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008201 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008202 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008203 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008204 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008205
8206 if (Unqualified)
8207 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
8208
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008209 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
8210 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008211 if (Unqualified) {
8212 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
8213 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
8214 }
8215
8216 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008217 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008218 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008219 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008220
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00008221 // FIXME: double check this
8222 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
8223 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
8224 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00008225 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
8226 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008227
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00008228 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008229 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00008230 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008231
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008232 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00008233 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
8234 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008235 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
8236 return QualType();
8237
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008238 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
8239 return QualType();
Oren Ben Simhon318a6ea2017-04-27 12:01:00 +00008240 if (lbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != rbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs())
8241 return QualType();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008242
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008243 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
8244 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008245
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00008246 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
8247 allLTypes = false;
8248 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
8249 allRTypes = false;
8250
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008251 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008252
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008253 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00008254 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
8255 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008256 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
8257 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008258 return QualType();
8259
8260 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
8261 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
8262 return QualType();
8263
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00008264 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
8265 return QualType();
8266
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008267 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> newParamInfos;
8268 bool canUseLeft, canUseRight;
8269 if (!mergeExtParameterInfo(lproto, rproto, canUseLeft, canUseRight,
8270 newParamInfos))
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008271 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008272
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008273 if (!canUseLeft)
8274 allLTypes = false;
8275 if (!canUseRight)
8276 allRTypes = false;
8277
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008278 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008279 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008280 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
8281 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
8282 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
8283 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
8284 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
8285 if (paramType.isNull())
8286 return QualType();
8287
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008288 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008289 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
8290
8291 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008292 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008293 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
8294 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008295 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008296
8297 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008298 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008299 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008300 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008301 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008302
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008303 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8304 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008305
8306 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
8307 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008308 EPI.ExtParameterInfos =
8309 newParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : newParamInfos.data();
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00008310 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008311 }
8312
8313 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
8314 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
8315
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008316 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008317 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00008318 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008319 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
8320 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
8321 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
8322 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
8323 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
8324 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008325 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
8326 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008327
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00008328 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00008329 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008330 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
8331 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8332 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00008333 return QualType();
8334 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008335
8336 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
8337 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008338 return QualType();
8339 }
8340
8341 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8342 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008343
8344 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
8345 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008346 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008347 }
8348
8349 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8350 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008351 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008352}
8353
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008354/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
8355static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
8356 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
8357 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
8358 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
8359 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
8360 // type.
8361 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8362 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
8363 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
8364 return other;
8365
8366 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
8367 // integral type of the same size.
8368 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
8369 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
8370 return other;
8371
8372 return QualType();
8373}
8374
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008375QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008376 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008377 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00008378 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
8379 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
8380 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00008381 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
8382 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008383 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
8384 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008385
8386 if (Unqualified) {
8387 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
8388 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
8389 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008390
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008391 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
8392 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
8393
8394 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
8395 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
8396 return LHS;
8397
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008398 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00008399 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8400 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008401 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
8402 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
8403 // mismatch.
8404 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008405 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
Roger Ferrer Ibanezd93add32017-02-24 08:41:09 +00008406 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime() ||
8407 LQuals.hasUnaligned() != RQuals.hasUnaligned())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008408 return QualType();
8409
8410 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
8411 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
8412 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
8413 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8414 // qualified __strong.
8415 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8416 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8417 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8418
8419 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8420 return QualType();
8421
8422 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8423 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
8424 }
8425 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8426 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
8427 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008428 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008429 }
8430
8431 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008432
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00008433 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
8434 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008435
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008436 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
8437 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
8438 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
8439 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00008440
8441 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008442 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8443 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
8444 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8445 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008446
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008447 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
8448 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8449 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8450
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00008451 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
8452 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
8453 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008454
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008455 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008456 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008457 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
8458 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008459 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008460 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008461 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008462 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008463 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008464 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008465 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00008466 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
8467 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
8468 return LHS;
8469 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
8470 return RHS;
8471 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008472
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008473 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008474 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008475
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00008476 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008477 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008478#define TYPE(Class, Base)
8479#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00008480#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008481#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8482#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8483#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008484 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008485
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00008486 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00008487 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00008488 case Type::LValueReference:
8489 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008490 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008491 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008492
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008493 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008494 case Type::IncompleteArray:
8495 case Type::VariableArray:
8496 case Type::FunctionProto:
8497 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008498 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008499
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008500 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008501 {
8502 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008503 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8504 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008505 if (Unqualified) {
8506 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8507 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8508 }
8509 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
8510 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008511 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008512 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008513 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008514 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008515 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008516 return getPointerType(ResultType);
8517 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008518 case Type::BlockPointer:
8519 {
8520 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008521 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8522 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008523 if (Unqualified) {
8524 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8525 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8526 }
Anastasia Stulova81a25e352017-03-10 15:23:07 +00008527 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
8528 Qualifiers LHSPteeQual = LHSPointee.getQualifiers();
8529 Qualifiers RHSPteeQual = RHSPointee.getQualifiers();
8530 // Blocks can't be an expression in a ternary operator (OpenCL v2.0
8531 // 6.12.5) thus the following check is asymmetric.
8532 if (!LHSPteeQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(RHSPteeQual))
8533 return QualType();
8534 LHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
8535 RHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
8536 LHSPointee =
8537 QualType(LHSPointee.getTypePtr(), LHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
8538 RHSPointee =
8539 QualType(RHSPointee.getTypePtr(), RHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
8540 }
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008541 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
8542 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008543 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8544 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8545 return LHS;
8546 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8547 return RHS;
8548 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
8549 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00008550 case Type::Atomic:
8551 {
8552 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
8553 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8554 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8555 if (Unqualified) {
8556 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8557 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8558 }
8559 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
8560 Unqualified);
8561 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8562 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8563 return LHS;
8564 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8565 return RHS;
8566 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
8567 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008568 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008569 {
8570 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
8571 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
8572 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
8573 return QualType();
8574
8575 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
8576 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008577 if (Unqualified) {
8578 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8579 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8580 }
8581
8582 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008583 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008584 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8585 return LHS;
8586 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8587 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008588 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
8589 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
8590 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
8591 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008592 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
8593 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008594 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8595 return LHS;
8596 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8597 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008598 if (LVAT) {
8599 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8600 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
8601 // has to be different.
8602 return LHS;
8603 }
8604 if (RVAT) {
8605 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8606 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
8607 // has to be different.
8608 return RHS;
8609 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008610 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
8611 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00008612 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
8613 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008614 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008615 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008616 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008617 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008618 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008619 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008620 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008621 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008622 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00008623 case Type::Complex:
8624 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
8625 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008626 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008627 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00008628 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
8629 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008630 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008631 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008632 case Type::ObjCObject: {
8633 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008634 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
8635 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008636 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8637 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8638 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00008639 return LHS;
8640
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008641 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00008642 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008643 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008644 if (OfBlockPointer) {
8645 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
8646 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008647 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8648 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008649 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008650 return QualType();
8651 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008652 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8653 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008654 return LHS;
8655
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00008656 return QualType();
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00008657 case Type::Pipe:
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00008658 assert(LHS != RHS &&
8659 "Equivalent pipe types should have already been handled!");
8660 return QualType();
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00008661 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008662
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008663 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008664}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00008665
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008666bool ASTContext::mergeExtParameterInfo(
8667 const FunctionProtoType *FirstFnType, const FunctionProtoType *SecondFnType,
8668 bool &CanUseFirst, bool &CanUseSecond,
8669 SmallVectorImpl<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo> &NewParamInfos) {
8670 assert(NewParamInfos.empty() && "param info list not empty");
8671 CanUseFirst = CanUseSecond = true;
8672 bool FirstHasInfo = FirstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
8673 bool SecondHasInfo = SecondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
8674
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008675 // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos,
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008676 // we match if and only if the second type also doesn't have them.
8677 if (!FirstHasInfo && !SecondHasInfo)
8678 return true;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008679
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008680 bool NeedParamInfo = false;
8681 size_t E = FirstHasInfo ? FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size()
8682 : SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size();
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008683
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008684 for (size_t I = 0; I < E; ++I) {
8685 FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo FirstParam, SecondParam;
8686 if (FirstHasInfo)
8687 FirstParam = FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
8688 if (SecondHasInfo)
8689 SecondParam = SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008690
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008691 // Cannot merge unless everything except the noescape flag matches.
8692 if (FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(false) != SecondParam.withIsNoEscape(false))
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008693 return false;
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008694
8695 bool FirstNoEscape = FirstParam.isNoEscape();
8696 bool SecondNoEscape = SecondParam.isNoEscape();
8697 bool IsNoEscape = FirstNoEscape && SecondNoEscape;
8698 NewParamInfos.push_back(FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(IsNoEscape));
8699 if (NewParamInfos.back().getOpaqueValue())
8700 NeedParamInfo = true;
8701 if (FirstNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
8702 CanUseFirst = false;
8703 if (SecondNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
8704 CanUseSecond = false;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008705 }
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008706
8707 if (!NeedParamInfo)
8708 NewParamInfos.clear();
8709
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008710 return true;
8711}
8712
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00008713void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
8714 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
8715}
8716
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008717/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
8718/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
8719/// return types.
8720QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8721 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
8722 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
8723 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
8724 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
8725 return LHS;
8726 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
8727 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
8728 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008729 QualType OldReturnType =
8730 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008731 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008732 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008733 QualType ResReturnType =
8734 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
8735 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
8736 return QualType();
8737 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
8738 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
8739 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
8740 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
8741 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008742 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
8743 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00008744 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008745 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008746 return ResultType;
8747 }
8748 }
8749 return QualType();
8750 }
8751
8752 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
8753 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8754 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8755 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
8756 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
8757 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
8758 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
8759 return QualType();
8760
8761 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
8762 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
8763 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
8764 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8765 // qualified __strong.
8766 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8767 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8768 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8769
8770 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8771 return QualType();
8772
8773 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
8774 return LHS;
8775 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
8776 return RHS;
8777 return QualType();
8778 }
8779
8780 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8781 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8782 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8783 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
8784 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
8785 return LHS;
8786 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
8787 return RHS;
8788 }
8789 return QualType();
8790}
8791
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00008792//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008793// Integer Predicates
8794//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00008795
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008796unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00008797 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00008798 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00008799 if (T->isBooleanType())
8800 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00008801 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008802 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
8803}
8804
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00008805QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00008806 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008807
8808 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
8809 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
8810 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008811 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008812
8813 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
8814 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008815 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008816
8817 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8818 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008819 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
8820 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
8821 case BuiltinType::SChar:
8822 return UnsignedCharTy;
8823 case BuiltinType::Short:
8824 return UnsignedShortTy;
8825 case BuiltinType::Int:
8826 return UnsignedIntTy;
8827 case BuiltinType::Long:
8828 return UnsignedLongTy;
8829 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
8830 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00008831 case BuiltinType::Int128:
8832 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008833 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008834 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008835 }
8836}
8837
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008838ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() = default;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00008839
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00008840void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
8841 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008842
8843//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8844// Builtin Type Computation
8845//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8846
8847/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008848/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
8849/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
8850/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
8851/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008852///
8853/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
8854/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008855static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008856 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00008857 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008858 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008859 // Modifiers.
8860 int HowLong = 0;
8861 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008862 RequiresICE = false;
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00008863
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008864 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008865 bool Done = false;
8866 #ifndef NDEBUG
8867 bool IsSpecialLong = false;
8868 #endif
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008869 while (!Done) {
8870 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008871 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008872 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008873 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008874 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008875 case 'S':
8876 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
8877 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
8878 Signed = true;
8879 break;
8880 case 'U':
8881 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008882 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008883 Unsigned = true;
8884 break;
8885 case 'L':
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008886 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use 'L' with 'W' or 'N' modifiers");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008887 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
8888 ++HowLong;
8889 break;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008890 case 'N':
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008891 // 'N' behaves like 'L' for all non LP64 targets and 'int' otherwise.
8892 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use two 'N' or 'W' modifiers!");
8893 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'N' modifiers!");
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008894 #ifndef NDEBUG
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008895 IsSpecialLong = true;
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008896 #endif
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008897 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32)
8898 ++HowLong;
8899 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008900 case 'W':
8901 // This modifier represents int64 type.
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008902 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use two 'N' or 'W' modifiers!");
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008903 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008904 #ifndef NDEBUG
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008905 IsSpecialLong = true;
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008906 #endif
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008907 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
8908 default:
8909 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
8910 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
8911 HowLong = 1;
8912 break;
8913 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
8914 HowLong = 2;
8915 break;
8916 }
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitheae8caa2017-06-14 21:26:31 +00008917 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008918 }
8919 }
8920
8921 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008922
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008923 // Read the base type.
8924 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008925 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008926 case 'v':
8927 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8928 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
8929 Type = Context.VoidTy;
8930 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008931 case 'h':
8932 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008933 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008934 Type = Context.HalfTy;
8935 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008936 case 'f':
8937 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8938 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
8939 Type = Context.FloatTy;
8940 break;
8941 case 'd':
8942 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8943 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
8944 if (HowLong)
8945 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
8946 else
8947 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
8948 break;
8949 case 's':
8950 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
8951 if (Unsigned)
8952 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
8953 else
8954 Type = Context.ShortTy;
8955 break;
8956 case 'i':
8957 if (HowLong == 3)
8958 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
8959 else if (HowLong == 2)
8960 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
8961 else if (HowLong == 1)
8962 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
8963 else
8964 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
8965 break;
8966 case 'c':
8967 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
8968 if (Signed)
8969 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
8970 else if (Unsigned)
8971 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
8972 else
8973 Type = Context.CharTy;
8974 break;
8975 case 'b': // boolean
8976 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
8977 Type = Context.BoolTy;
8978 break;
8979 case 'z': // size_t.
8980 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
8981 Type = Context.getSizeType();
8982 break;
Richard Smith8110c9d2016-11-29 19:45:17 +00008983 case 'w': // wchar_t.
8984 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'w'!");
8985 Type = Context.getWideCharType();
8986 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008987 case 'F':
8988 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
8989 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00008990 case 'G':
8991 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
8992 break;
8993 case 'H':
8994 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
8995 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00008996 case 'M':
8997 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
8998 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008999 case 'a':
9000 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
9001 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
9002 break;
9003 case 'A':
9004 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
9005 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
9006 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
9007 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
9008 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
9009 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
9010 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
9011 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
9012 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
9013 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009014 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009015 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009016 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009017 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009018 break;
9019 case 'V': {
9020 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009021 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
9022 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009023 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009024
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009025 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
9026 RequiresICE, false);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009027 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009028
9029 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00009030 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00009031 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009032 break;
9033 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00009034 case 'E': {
9035 char *End;
9036
9037 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
9038 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
9039
9040 Str = End;
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009041
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00009042 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009043 false);
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00009044 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
9045 break;
9046 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00009047 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009048 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009049 false);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009050 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00009051 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
9052 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00009053 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009054 case 'Y':
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00009055 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
9056 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00009057 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00009058 Type = Context.getFILEType();
9059 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009060 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009061 return QualType();
9062 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00009063 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00009064 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009065 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00009066 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009067 else
9068 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
9069
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00009070 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009071 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00009072 return QualType();
9073 }
9074 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00009075 case 'K':
9076 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
9077 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
9078
9079 if (Type.isNull()) {
9080 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
9081 return QualType();
9082 }
9083 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00009084 case 'p':
9085 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
9086 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00009087 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009088
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009089 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
9090 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009091 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00009092 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009093 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
9094 case '*':
9095 case '&': {
9096 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
9097 // qualified with an address space.
9098 char *End;
9099 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
9100 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009101 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type,
9102 getLangASFromTargetAS(AddrSpace));
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009103 Str = End;
9104 }
9105 if (c == '*')
9106 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
9107 else
9108 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
9109 break;
9110 }
9111 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
9112 case 'C':
9113 Type = Type.withConst();
9114 break;
9115 case 'D':
9116 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
9117 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00009118 case 'R':
9119 Type = Type.withRestrict();
9120 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009121 }
9122 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00009123
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009124 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00009125 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009126
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009127 return Type;
9128}
9129
9130/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009131QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
9132 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
9133 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Eric Christopher02d5d862015-08-06 01:01:12 +00009134 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009135
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009136 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009137
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009138 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009139 Error = GE_None;
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009140 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
9141 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009142 if (Error != GE_None)
9143 return QualType();
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009144
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009145 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009146
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009147 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009148 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009149 if (Error != GE_None)
9150 return QualType();
9151
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009152 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
9153 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
9154 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
9155 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
9156
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009157 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
9158 if (Ty->isArrayType())
9159 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009160
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009161 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
9162 }
9163
David Majnemerba3e5ec2015-03-13 18:26:17 +00009164 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
9165 return QualType();
9166
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009167 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
9168 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
9169
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009170 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00009171 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
9172
9173 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
9174
Richard Smith836de6b2016-12-19 23:59:34 +00009175 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here.
9176 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00009177 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00009178
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00009179 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00009180 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
9181 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
Richard Smith391fb862016-10-18 07:13:55 +00009182 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(Id))
9183 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
9184 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_DynamicNone;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00009185
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00009186 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009187}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00009188
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009189static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
9190 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009191 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009192 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009193
Richard Smithe2467b72017-11-16 23:54:56 +00009194 // Non-user-provided functions get emitted as weak definitions with every
9195 // use, no matter whether they've been explicitly instantiated etc.
9196 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
9197 if (!MD->isUserProvided())
9198 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
9199
Yaron Keren4cd211b2017-02-22 14:32:39 +00009200 GVALinkage External;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009201 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
9202 case TSK_Undeclared:
9203 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
9204 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
9205 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009206
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009207 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009208 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009209
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00009210 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
9211 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
9212 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
9213 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
9214 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
9215 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009216 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009217 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
9218
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009219 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009220 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009221 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009222 }
9223
9224 if (!FD->isInlined())
9225 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00009226
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00009227 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
9228 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009229 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00009230 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009231 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
9232
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009233 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
9234 // externally visible.
9235 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
9236 return External;
9237
9238 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009239 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009240 }
9241
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009242 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
9243 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
9244 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
David Majnemer73768702015-03-20 00:02:27 +00009245 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009246 return GVA_StrongODR;
9247
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009248 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009249}
9250
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00009251static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext &Context,
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009252 const Decl *D, GVALinkage L) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009253 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
9254 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
9255 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
9256 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
9257 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00009258 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009259 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
9260 return GVA_StrongODR;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00009261 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice &&
9262 D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
9263 // Device-side functions with __global__ attribute must always be
9264 // visible externally so they can be launched from host.
9265 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_Internal)
9266 return GVA_StrongODR;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009267 }
9268 return L;
9269}
9270
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009271/// Adjust the GVALinkage for a declaration based on what an external AST source
9272/// knows about whether there can be other definitions of this declaration.
9273static GVALinkage
9274adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(const ASTContext &Ctx, const Decl *D,
9275 GVALinkage L) {
9276 ExternalASTSource *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
9277 if (!Source)
9278 return L;
9279
9280 switch (Source->hasExternalDefinitions(D)) {
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009281 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Never:
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009282 // Other translation units rely on us to provide the definition.
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009283 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
9284 return GVA_StrongODR;
9285 break;
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009286
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009287 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Always:
9288 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009289
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009290 case ExternalASTSource::EK_ReplyHazy:
9291 break;
9292 }
9293 return L;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009294}
9295
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009296GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
9297 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, FD,
9298 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, FD,
9299 basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD)));
9300}
9301
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009302static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
9303 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009304 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
9305 return GVA_Internal;
9306
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009307 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009308 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
9309 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
9310 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
9311
David Blaikieeb210012017-01-27 23:11:10 +00009312 // ObjC Blocks can create local variables that don't have a FunctionDecl
9313 // LexicalContext.
9314 if (!LexicalContext)
9315 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009316
David Blaikieeb210012017-01-27 23:11:10 +00009317 // Otherwise, let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the
9318 // nearest enclosing function.
9319 auto StaticLocalLinkage =
9320 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
9321
9322 // Itanium ABI 5.2.2: "Each COMDAT group [for a static local variable] must
9323 // be emitted in any object with references to the symbol for the object it
9324 // contains, whether inline or out-of-line."
9325 // Similar behavior is observed with MSVC. An alternative ABI could use
9326 // StrongODR/AvailableExternally to match the function, but none are
9327 // known/supported currently.
9328 if (StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ||
9329 StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
9330 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
9331 return StaticLocalLinkage;
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009332 }
9333
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00009334 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
9335 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
9336 // cause link errors.
9337 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
9338 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
9339
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00009340 // Most non-template variables have strong linkage; inline variables are
9341 // linkonce_odr or (occasionally, for compatibility) weak_odr.
9342 GVALinkage StrongLinkage;
9343 switch (Context.getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(VD)) {
9344 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None:
9345 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongExternal;
9346 break;
9347 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak:
9348 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009349 StrongLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00009350 break;
9351 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong:
9352 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongODR;
9353 break;
9354 }
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009355
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00009356 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009357 case TSK_Undeclared:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009358 return StrongLinkage;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009359
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00009360 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00009361 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
9362 VD->isStaticDataMember()
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00009363 ? GVA_StrongODR
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009364 : StrongLinkage;
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00009365
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009366 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009367 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009368
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009369 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
9370 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
9371
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009372 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009373 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009374 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00009375
9376 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009377}
9378
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009379GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009380 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, VD,
9381 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, VD,
9382 basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD)));
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009383}
9384
David Blaikiee6b7c282017-04-11 20:46:34 +00009385bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009386 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
9387 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
9388 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00009389 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
9390 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
9391 return false;
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00009392 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
9393 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
9394 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00009395 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
9396 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
9397 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
9398 return false;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00009399 } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D))
9400 return true;
Dmitry Polukhin0b0da292016-04-06 11:38:59 +00009401 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D) ||
9402 D->hasAttr<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr>())
9403 return true;
Nico Webercbbaeb12016-03-02 19:28:54 +00009404 else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D))
9405 return true;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00009406 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
Alexey Bataevc5b1d322016-03-04 09:22:22 +00009407 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
9408 else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D))
9409 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +00009410 else if (isa<ImportDecl>(D))
9411 return true;
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00009412 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00009413 return false;
9414
9415 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
9416 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009417 return false;
9418
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00009419 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
9420 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
9421 return false;
9422
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009423 // Aliases and used decls are required.
9424 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
9425 return true;
9426
9427 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
9428 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00009429 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00009430 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009431
9432 // Constructors and destructors are required.
9433 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
9434 return true;
9435
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00009436 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
9437 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
9438 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
9439 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
9440 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
9441 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
9442 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
9443 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
9444 return true;
9445 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009446 }
9447 }
9448
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009449 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
9450
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009451 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
9452 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
9453 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009454 return !isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009455 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00009456
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009457 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
9458 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
9459
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00009460 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
9461 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00009462 return false;
9463
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009464 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009465 auto Linkage = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
9466 if (!isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage))
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009467 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009468
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009469 // We never need to emit a variable that is available in another TU.
9470 if (Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
9471 return false;
9472
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009473 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
9474 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
9475 return true;
9476
9477 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00009478 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
Richard Smith187ffb42017-01-20 01:19:46 +00009479 // We can get a value-dependent initializer during error recovery.
9480 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue()))
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009481 return true;
9482
Richard Smithda383632016-08-15 01:33:41 +00009483 // Likewise, variables with tuple-like bindings are required if their
9484 // bindings have side-effects.
9485 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(VD))
9486 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
9487 if (auto *BindingVD = BD->getHoldingVar())
9488 if (DeclMustBeEmitted(BindingVD))
9489 return true;
9490
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009491 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009492}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00009493
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009494CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
9495 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00009496 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009497 if (IsCXXMethod)
9498 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00009499
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009500 switch (LangOpts.getDefaultCallingConv()) {
9501 case LangOptions::DCC_None:
9502 break;
9503 case LangOptions::DCC_CDecl:
9504 return CC_C;
9505 case LangOptions::DCC_FastCall:
Erich Keane5759fa72017-10-24 23:12:01 +00009506 if (getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sse2") && !IsVariadic)
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009507 return CC_X86FastCall;
9508 break;
9509 case LangOptions::DCC_StdCall:
9510 if (!IsVariadic)
9511 return CC_X86StdCall;
9512 break;
9513 case LangOptions::DCC_VectorCall:
9514 // __vectorcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
9515 if (!IsVariadic)
9516 return CC_X86VectorCall;
9517 break;
Erich Keanea957ffb2017-11-02 21:08:00 +00009518 case LangOptions::DCC_RegCall:
9519 // __regcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
9520 if (!IsVariadic)
9521 return CC_X86RegCall;
9522 break;
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009523 }
Alexander Kornienko21de0ae2015-01-20 11:20:41 +00009524 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00009525}
9526
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00009527bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00009528 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
9529 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
9530}
9531
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00009532VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
9533 if (!VTContext.get()) {
9534 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9535 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
9536 else
9537 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
9538 }
9539 return VTContext.get();
9540}
9541
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009542MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009543 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00009544 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009545 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
9546 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +00009547 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009548 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00009549 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +00009550 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +00009551 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009552 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009553 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009554 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009555 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009556 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009557}
9558
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009559CXXABI::~CXXABI() = default;
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009560
9561size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00009562 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
9563 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
9564 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
9565 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
9566 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
9567 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
9568 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
9569 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
9570 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
9571 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
9572 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
9573 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
9574 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
9575 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009576}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009577
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009578/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
9579/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
9580/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
9581/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9582QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
9583 unsigned Signed) const {
9584 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
9585 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
9586 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
9587 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
9588 return QualTy;
9589}
9590
9591/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
9592/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
9593/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9594QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
9595 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
9596 switch (Ty) {
9597 case TargetInfo::Float:
9598 return FloatTy;
9599 case TargetInfo::Double:
9600 return DoubleTy;
9601 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
9602 return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00009603 case TargetInfo::Float128:
9604 return Float128Ty;
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009605 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
9606 return QualType();
9607 }
9608
9609 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
9610}
9611
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009612void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
9613 if (Number > 1)
9614 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009615}
9616
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009617unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009618 auto I = MangleNumbers.find(ND);
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009619 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009620}
9621
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009622void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
9623 if (Number > 1)
9624 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
9625}
9626
9627unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009628 auto I = StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009629 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
9630}
9631
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009632MangleNumberingContext &
9633ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009634 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009635 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009636 if (!MCtx)
9637 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
9638 return *MCtx;
9639}
9640
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009641std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext>
9642ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009643 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00009644}
9645
David Majnemere7a818f2015-03-06 18:53:55 +00009646const CXXConstructorDecl *
9647ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
9648 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9649 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
9650}
9651
9652void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
9653 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
9654 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9655 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
9656 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
9657}
9658
David Majnemer00350522015-08-31 18:48:39 +00009659void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9660 TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
9661 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9662}
9663
9664TypedefNameDecl *
9665ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9666 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9667}
9668
9669void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9670 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
9671 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9672}
9673
9674DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9675 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9676}
9677
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009678void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
9679 ParamIndices[D] = index;
9680}
9681
9682unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
9683 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
9684 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
9685 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
9686 return I->second;
9687}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009688
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009689APValue *
9690ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
9691 bool MayCreate) {
9692 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
9693 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009694 if (MayCreate) {
9695 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
9696 if (!MTVI)
9697 MTVI = new (*this) APValue;
9698 return MTVI;
9699 }
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009700
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009701 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E);
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009702}
9703
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009704bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
9705 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
9706 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
9707 return false;
9708
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00009709 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
9710 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
9711 return false;
9712
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009713 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
9714 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
9715 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
9716 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
9717 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
9718 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
9719 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
9720}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009721
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009722static ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009723 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers::mapped_type U) {
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009724 if (const auto *D = U.dyn_cast<const Decl *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009725 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*D);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009726 if (const auto *S = U.dyn_cast<const Stmt *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009727 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*S);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009728 return *U.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009729}
9730
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009731namespace {
9732
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009733/// Template specializations to abstract away from pointers and TypeLocs.
9734/// @{
9735template <typename T>
9736ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const T &Node) {
9737 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node);
9738}
9739template <>
9740ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const TypeLoc &Node) {
9741 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9742}
9743template <>
9744ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode
9745createDynTypedNode(const NestedNameSpecifierLoc &Node) {
9746 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9747}
9748/// @}
9749
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009750 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
9751 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
9752 ///
9753 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
9754 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
9755 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
9756 ///
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009757 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009758 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009759 public:
9760 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
9761 ///
9762 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009763 static std::pair<ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *,
9764 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *>
9765 buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
9766 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMapPointers,
9767 new ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009768 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009769 return std::make_pair(Visitor.Parents, Visitor.OtherParents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009770 }
9771
9772 private:
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009773 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
9774
9775 using VisitorBase = RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009776
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009777 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents,
9778 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents)
9779 : Parents(Parents), OtherParents(OtherParents) {}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009780
9781 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
9782 return true;
9783 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009784
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009785 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
9786 return true;
9787 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009788
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009789 template <typename T, typename MapNodeTy, typename BaseTraverseFn,
9790 typename MapTy>
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009791 bool TraverseNode(T Node, MapNodeTy MapNode,
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009792 BaseTraverseFn BaseTraverse, MapTy *Parents) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00009793 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009794 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009795 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009796 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
9797 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
9798 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
9799 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
9800 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
9801 // new matches.
9802 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
9803 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
9804 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
9805 // do not have pointer identity.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009806 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[MapNode];
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009807 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009808 if (const auto *D = ParentStack.back().get<Decl>())
9809 NodeOrVector = D;
9810 else if (const auto *S = ParentStack.back().get<Stmt>())
9811 NodeOrVector = S;
9812 else
9813 NodeOrVector =
9814 new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009815 } else {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009816 if (!NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
9817 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(
9818 1, getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(NodeOrVector));
Gabor Horvath10a837a2017-04-19 15:11:10 +00009819 delete NodeOrVector
9820 .template dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer422b3ff2015-10-23 13:24:18 +00009821 NodeOrVector = Vector;
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009822 }
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009823
9824 auto *Vector =
9825 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
9826 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
9827 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
9828 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
9829 // types.
9830 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
9831 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
9832 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
9833 if (!Found)
9834 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009835 }
9836 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009837 ParentStack.push_back(createDynTypedNode(Node));
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009838 bool Result = BaseTraverse();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009839 ParentStack.pop_back();
9840 return Result;
9841 }
9842
9843 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009844 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, DeclNode,
9845 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseDecl(DeclNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009846 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009847 }
9848
9849 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009850 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, StmtNode,
9851 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseStmt(StmtNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009852 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009853 }
9854
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009855 bool TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLoc TypeLocNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009856 return TraverseNode(
9857 TypeLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(TypeLocNode),
9858 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLocNode); },
9859 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009860 }
9861
9862 bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLocNode) {
9863 return TraverseNode(
9864 NNSLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(NNSLocNode),
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009865 [&] {
9866 return VisitorBase::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NNSLocNode);
9867 },
9868 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009869 }
9870
9871 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents;
9872 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009873 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009874 };
9875
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009876} // namespace
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009877
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009878template <typename NodeTy, typename MapTy>
9879static ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList getDynNodeFromMap(const NodeTy &Node,
9880 const MapTy &Map) {
9881 auto I = Map.find(Node);
9882 if (I == Map.end()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009883 return llvm::ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009884 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009885 if (auto *V = I->second.template dyn_cast<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009886 return llvm::makeArrayRef(*V);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009887 }
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009888 return getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(I->second);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009889}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009890
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009891ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList
9892ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
9893 if (!PointerParents) {
9894 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
9895 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
9896 auto Maps = ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl());
9897 PointerParents.reset(Maps.first);
9898 OtherParents.reset(Maps.second);
9899 }
9900 if (Node.getNodeKind().hasPointerIdentity())
9901 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node.getMemoizationData(), *PointerParents);
9902 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node, *OtherParents);
9903}
9904
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009905bool
9906ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
9907 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
9908 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
9909 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
9910 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
9911 return false;
9912 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
9913 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9914 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00009915 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009916 return false;
9917
9918 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
9919 return false;
9920
9921 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
9922 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
9923 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
9924 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
9925 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
9926 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
9927 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9928 return false;
9929 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
9930 return false;
9931 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009932
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009933 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009934}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009935
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009936uint64_t ASTContext::getTargetNullPointerValue(QualType QT) const {
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009937 LangAS AS;
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009938 if (QT->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()->isNullPtrType())
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009939 AS = LangAS::Default;
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009940 else
9941 AS = QT->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
9942
9943 return getTargetInfo().getNullPointerValue(AS);
9944}
9945
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009946unsigned ASTContext::getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS AS) const {
9947 if (isTargetAddressSpace(AS))
9948 return toTargetAddressSpace(AS);
Yaxun Liub34ec822017-04-11 17:24:23 +00009949 else
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009950 return (*AddrSpaceMap)[(unsigned)AS];
Yaxun Liub34ec822017-04-11 17:24:23 +00009951}
9952
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009953// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
9954// doesn't include ASTContext.h
9955template
9956clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9957 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
9958clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9959 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
9960 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);